P12x Ent f65 PDF
P12x Ent f65 PDF
P12x Ent f65 PDF
P120/P121/P122/
P123
Overcurrent Relays
Version 6
Technical Guide
P12x/EN T/F65
Technical Guide P12x/EN T/F65
Contents
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 1/2
CONTENTS
BLANK PAGE
Pxxxx/EN SS/B11
SAFETY SECTION
Pxxxx/EN SS/B11
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION 3
3.1 Symbols 4
3.2 Labels 4
7.4 Environment 8
8. CE MARKING 8
BLANK PAGE
Pxxxx/EN SS/B11
1. INTRODUCTION
This guide and the relevant operating or service manual documentation for the equipment
provide full information on safe handling, commissioning and testing of this equipment and
also includes descriptions of equipment label markings.
Documentation for equipment ordered from AREVA Energy Automation & Information is
despatched separately from manufactured goods and may not be received at the same time.
Therefore this guide is provided to ensure that printed information normally present on
equipment is fully understood by the recipient.
Before carrying out any work on the equipment the user should be familiar with
the contents of this Safety Guide.
Reference should be made to the external connection diagram before the equipment is
installed, commissioned or serviced.
Language specific, self-adhesive User Interface labels are provided in a bag for some
equipment.
• are familiar with the installation, commissioning, and operation of the equipment and
of the system to which it is being connected;
• are able to safely perform switching operations in accordance with accepted safety
engineering practices and are authorised to energize and de-energize equipment
and to isolate, ground, and label it;
• are trained in the care and use of safety apparatus in accordance with safety
engineering practices;
3.1 Symbols
*NOTE: THE TERM EARTH USED THROUGHOUT THIS GUIDE IS THE DIRECT
EQUIVALENT OF THE NORTH AMERICAN TERM GROUND.
3.2 Labels
See "Safety Guide" (SFTY/4L M) for equipment labelling information.
DANGER - CTs must NOT be fused since open circuiting them may
produce lethal hazardous voltages.
7.4 Environment
The equipment is intended for indoor installation and use only. If it is required for use in an
outdoor environment then it must be mounted in a specific cabinet or housing which will
enable it to meet the requirements of IEC 60529 with the classification of degree of
protection IP54 (dust and splashing water protected).
8. CE MARKING
Compliance with all relevant European
Marking Community directives:
Where applicable :
BLANK PAGE
Introduction P12x/EN IT/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Introduction
Introduction P12x/EN IT/F65
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION 3
4. MAIN FUNCTIONS 6
5. EQUIVALENCE TABLES 7
P12x/EN IT/F65 Introduction
BLANK PAGE
Introduction P12x/EN IT/F65
1. INTRODUCTION
The overcurrent relays of the MiCOM P120 range are AREVA T&D'S Automation &
Information Systems Business universal overcurrent relays. The MiCOM P120, P121, P122
and P123 relays have been designed to control, protect and monitor industrial installations,
public distribution networks and substations, and to be used as back-up protection for EHV
and HV transmission networks.
P12x/EN IT/F65 Introduction
4. MAIN FUNCTIONS
The following table shows the functions available in the various models of the MiCOM P120
range of relays.
5. EQUIVALENCE TABLES
The following section describes the models of the MiCOM P120 range together with other
existing relays in the AREVA T&D'S Automation & Information Systems Business and
GEC-ALSTHOM catalogues :
BLANK PAGE
Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions P12x/EN IN/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CONTENTS
1. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS 3
1.1 Receipt of relays 3
1.2 Electrostatic discharge (ESD) 3
3. RELAY MOUNTING 5
4. UNPACKING 6
5. STORAGE 7
6. DIMENSIONS 8
6.1 Connection of power terminals, and Signals terminals 8
6.2 Communication port RS485 9
6.3 Earthing 9
7. CASE DIMENSIONS 10
P12x/EN IN/F65 Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions
BLANK PAGE
Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions P12x/EN IN/F65
1. GENERAL CONSIDERATIONS
1.1 Receipt of relays
Protective relays, although generally of robust construction, require careful treatment prior to
installation on site. Upon receipt, relays should be examined immediately to ensure no
damage has been sustained in transit. If damage has been sustained during transit a claim
should be made to the transport contractor and AREVA T&D'S Automation & Information
Systems Business should be promptly notified.
Relays that are supplied unmounted and not intended for immediate installation should be
returned to their protective polythene bags.
1.2 Electrostatic discharge (ESD)
The relays use components that are sensitive to electrostatic discharges.
The electronic circuits are well protected by the metal case and the internal module should
not be withdrawn unnecessarily. When handling the module outside its case, care should be
taken to avoid contact with components and electrical connections. If removed from the case
for storage, the module should be placed in an electrically conducting antistatic bag.
There are no setting adjustments within the module and it is advised that it is not
unnecessarily disassembled. Although the printed circuit boards are plugged together, the
connectors are a manufacturing aid and not intended for frequent dismantling; in fact
considerable effort may be required to separate them. Touching the printed circuit board
should be avoided, since complementary metal oxide semiconductors (CMOS) are used,
which can be damaged by static electricity discharged from the body.
P12x/EN IN/F65 Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions
3. RELAY MOUNTING
Relays are dispatched either individually or as part of a panel/rack assembly.
If an MMLG test block is to be included it should be positioned at the right-hand side of the
assembly (viewed from the front). Modules should remain protected by their metal case
during assembly into a panel or rack.
For individually mounted relays an outline diagram is supplied in section 6 of this chapter
showing the panel cut-outs and hole centres.
P12x/EN IN/F65 Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions
4. UNPACKING
Care must be taken when unpacking and installing the relays so that none of the parts is
damaged or the settings altered. Relays must only be handled by skilled persons. The
installation should be clean, dry and reasonably free from dust and excessive vibration. The
site should be well lit to facilitate inspection. Relays that have been removed from their cases
should not be left in situations where they are exposed to dust or damp. This particularly
applies to installations which are being carried out at the same time as construction work.
Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions P12x/EN IN/F65
5. STORAGE
If relays are not to be installed immediately upon receipt they should be stored in a place
free from dust and moisture in their original cartons. Where de-humidifier bags have been
included in the packing they should be retained. The action of the de-humidifier crystals will
be impaired if the bag has been exposed to ambient conditions and may be restored by
gently heating the bag for about an hour, prior to replacing it in the carton.
Dust which collects on a carton may, on subsequent unpacking, find its way into the relay; in
damp conditions the carton and packing may become impregnated with moisture and the de-
humifier will lose its efficiency.
Storage temperature : –25°C to +70°C.
P12x/EN IN/F65 Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions
6. DIMENSIONS
6.1 Connection of power terminals, and Signals terminals
The individual equipment are delivered with sufficient M4 screws to connect the relay via
annular terminals, with a maximum recommended of two annular terminals per contact.
If necessary, AREVA T&D'S Automation & Information Systems Business can provide
annular terminals to crimp. 5 references exist according to the section of the wire (see
below). Each reference corresponds to a sachet of 100 terminals.
P0166ENb
P0167ENb
Handling, Installation and Case Dimensions P12x/EN IN/F65
To insure the insulation of the terminals and to respect the security and safety instructions,
an isolated sleeve can be used.
We recommend the following cable cross-sections:
7. CASE DIMENSIONS
MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays are available in a 4U metal case for panel or
flush mounting.
Weight : 1.7 to 2.1 Kg
External size : Height case 152 mm
front panel 177 mm
Width case 97 mm
front panel 103 mm
Depth case 226 mm
front panel + case 252 mm
39 39
97 26 26
All dimensions
in mm
168 158
Panel cut-out
Flush mounting fiwing details
IA = 214.50A
Trip
Alarm C
Equip.fail
Auxiliary
supply 177 151.2 max.
AUX. 1
AUX. 2
AUX. 3
AUX. 4
Flush mounting
P0001ENa
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
User Guide
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
CONTENTS
2. USER INTERFACE 6
2.1 LCD display and keypad description 6
2.1.1 LCD display 6
2.1.2 Keypad 6
2.1.2.1 ALARM keys 6
2.1.2.2 Programming keypad 7
2.2 LEDs 7
2.3 The two areas under the top and bottom flaps 8
2.4 The battery box 8
3. MENUS 9
3.1 Default display 9
3.2 Access to the menu 9
3.3 Password 9
3.3.1 Password protection 9
3.3.2 Entering the password 9
3.3.3 Changing the password 10
3.4 ALARM display 10
3.4.1 Electrical system ALARMS 11
3.4.2 Relay Hardware or Software ALARMS 13
3.5 Menu contents description 14
3.5.1 OP PARAMETERS Menu 16
3.5.1.1 P121, P122 and P123 additional OP.PARAMETERS Menu 16
3.5.1.2 P122 and P123 additional OP.PARAMETERS Menu 17
3.5.2 CONFIGURATION Menu 17
3.5.2.1 DISPLAY sub-menu 17
3.5.2.2 CT RATIO sub-menu 18
3.5.2.3 LED 5 to 8 configuration sub-menus 18
3.5.2.4 Group. Select sub-menu (P122 & P123 only) 22
3.5.2.5 Alarms sub-menu (P122 & P123 only) 22
3.5.2.6 Configuration inputs sub-menu (P122 & P123 only) 23
3.5.2.7 Configuration Relays Maintenance sub-menu (P122 & P123 only) 24
3.5.2.8 Configuration Phase Rotation sub-menu (P122 & P123 only) 24
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
4. WIRING 56
4.1 Auxiliary supply 56
4.2 Current measurement inputs 56
4.3 Logic inputs 56
4.4 Output relays 56
4.5 Communication 57
4.5.1 RS485 rear communication port 57
4.5.2 RS232 front communication port (P122 & P123 only) 57
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
BLANK PAGE
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
2. USER INTERFACE
The MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relay front panel serves as an interface between
the user and the protection relay. It enables the user to enter relay settings, display the
measured values, alarms and display clearly the various actions carried out by MiCOM
P120, P121, P122 and P123 relay.
Tripled Trip C
alarm led Alarm
Aux. 1
Aux. 2
P0005ENc
3. MENUS
The menu of the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays is organised into main and sub
menus. The content of these menus depends on the MiCOM model.
3.1 Default display
By default, the current value (selected phase or earth) is continuously displayed.
As soon as an alarm is generated by the MiCOM relay, that information is considered as
priority and replaces the default value.
The default display choice is made in the CONFIGURATION/Display menu.
3.2 Access to the menu
Complete menu access is performed by manipulation of the keys # $ % &. The general
arrangement of the menus is shown in figure 2 for P120 and P121 and figure 3 for P122 and
P123.
Reading of parameters and measurements is possible without entering the password.
Modification of the parameters requires entering the password.
Should an error be made in entering a parameter, press ! to cancel.
Except for reading and cancelling, the keys ! and " are inactive.
NOTE : The letter P is displayed when the password is entered. If no key is
pushed during 5 minutes, the password becomes inactive.
3.3 Password
3.3.1 Password protection
Password protection is applicable to the relay settings, especially to the selection of the
various thresholds, time delays, communication parameters, allocation of inputs and outputs
relays.
The password consists of four alphabetical capital characters. When leaving the factory, the
password is AAAA. The user can define his own combination of characters.
Should the password be lost or forgotten, the modification of the stored parameters of the
relay is prohibited. It is then necessary to contact the manufacturer or his agent by specifying
the serial number of the relay so as to receive a stand-by password specific to the relay
concerned.
NOTE : – The programming mode is showed with the letter "P" on the Low
right of the display on each head menu. The letter “P” is
present as long as the password is active (5 minutes if no key
is pushed).
– As soon as the password has been entered, no setting change
using the communication (RS485 or RS232) can be accepted.
3.3.2 Entering the password
The input of the password is requested as soon as a modification of a parameter is made for
any one of the menus or sub-menus. The user enters for each of the 4 characters/letters and
validates the entire password with '.
After 5 seconds, the display returns to the point of the preceding menu.
If no action is taken on the keypad for 5 minutes, the password is deactivated. A new request
shall be associated with any subsequent parameter modification.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
⇒ If one or several messages are NOT READ and NOT ACKNOWLEDGED, the
alarm LED flashes.
⇒ If all the messages have been READ but NOT ACKNOWLEDGED, the alarm LED
remains lights up continuously.
⇒ If all the messages have been READ and ACKNOWLEDGED, the alarm LED goes
out.
NOTE : – The alarms concerning the instantaneous can be selected self
reset Yes or No in the CONFIGURATION/Alarms Menu
– The reset of the relay latched is described in the sub-menu
content description.
The different electrical systems alarms are described below:
Ie> 1st stage earth fault pick-up
Ie>> 2nd stage earth fault pick-up
Ie>>> 3rd stage earth fault pick-up
I> PHASE 1st stage overcurrent pick-up
I>> PHASE 2nd stage overcurrent pick-up
I>>> PHASE 3rd stage overcurrent pick-up
tIe> 1st stage earth fault time-out
tIe>> 2nd stage earth fault time-out
tIe>>> 3rd stage earth fault time-out
tI> PHASE 1st stage overcurrent time-out
tI>> PHASE 2nd stage overcurrent time-out
tI>>> PHASE 3rd stage overcurrent time-out
THERMAL ALARM thermal alarm threshold pick-up
THERMAL TRIP thermal trip threshold pick-up
I< undercurrent element pick-up
tI< PHASE undercurrent fault time-out
BRKN COND. broken conductor indication. I2/I1 element pick-up for longer
than tBC. TBC is settable in the AUTOMAT. CTRL/Broken
cond. menu.
t AUX 1 t AUX1 time-out
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
⇒ If the fault is major (the relay cannot perform protection functions), the WARNING
LED is lit fixed.
⇒ If the fault is minor (no influence on the protection and automation function
e.g.communication failure), the WARNING LED is flashing.
Possible Hardware or Software alarm messages :
Major fault
The protection and automation functions are stopped.
The RL0 watchdog relay is de-energised (35-36 contact closed).
NOTE : The <<Battery backed RAM memory>> and <<Battery failure>> alarm
messages can be configured displayed yes or no, in
CONFIGURATION/Alarms menu.
⇒ OP PARAMETERS
⇒ CONFIGURATION
⇒ MEASUREMENTS
⇒ COMMUNICATION
⇒ PROTECTION G(1)
⇒ AUTOMAT. CTRL
CONFIGURATION
MEASUREMENTS
COMMUNICATION
PROTECTION
AUTOMAT. CTRL
P0003ENa
CONFIGURATION
MEASUREMENTS
COMMUNICATION
PROTECTION G1
PROTECTION G2
AUTOMAT. CTRL
RECORDS
P0004ENa
Date Displays the date. To modify this date press ' then using
12/08/02 % to enter the required value. Enable your choice using '
with this example the date is : 12 August 2002.
Time Displays the hour. To modify this hour press ' then using
13:57:44 % to enter the required value. Enable your choice using '
with this example the time is : 13 hours, 57 minutes, 44
seconds.
⇒ Display
⇒ CT Ratio
⇒ Led 5
⇒ Led 6
⇒ Led 7
⇒ Led 8
Default Display Display of the default current value (by selecting either
RMS I A Phase A, Phase B , Phase C, Earth N, or the four values
simultaneously). To modify this default value, press '
then using % to enter the required value.
Enable your choice using '.
Phase A Text Edit phase A label by selecting A, L1, or R. This value can
A be modified after entering the password and is displayed
with the corresponding measurement.
Phase B Text Edit phase B label by selecting B, L2, or S. This value can
B be modified after entering the password and is displayed
with the corresponding measurement.
Phase C Text Edit phase C label by selecting C, L3, or T. This value can
C be modified after entering the password and is displayed
with the corresponding measurement.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
WARNING : This DISPLAY sub-menu does not exist for MiCOM P121.
The default display is IA and A,B, C, N for the labels.
3.5.2.2 CT RATIO sub-menu
Line CT primary Display of the primary ratio of the phase CT. The value
1000 consists of 4 digits: Minimum 1, Maximum 9999.
Press ' to modify this value and use # $ % & to display
the new primary phase CT ratio. Enable your choice using
' at the end of selection
Line CT sec Display of the secondary ratio of the phase CT.
5 This value toggles between 1 and 5.
E/Gnd CT primary Display of the primary ratio of the earth CT. The consist of
1000 4 digits : Minimum 1, Maximum 9999.
Press ' to modify this value and use # $ % & to display
the new primary earth CT ratio. Enable your choice using
' at the end of selection.
E/Gnd CT sec Display of the secondary ratio of the earth CT.
5 This value toggles between 1 and 5.
TEXT Information
I> Instantaneous first phase threshold
I>> Instantaneous second phase threshold
I>>> Instantaneous third phase threshold
tI> Time delayed first phase threshold
tI>> Time delayed second phase threshold
tI>>> Time delayed third phase threshold
Ie> Instantaneous first earth threshold
Ie>> Instantaneous second earth threshold
Ie>>> Instantaneous third earth threshold
tIe> Time delayed first earth threshold
tIe>> Time delayed second earth threshold
tIe>>> Time delayed third earth threshold
Therm Trip Trip on Thermal overload
Brkn Cond. Broken conductor detection
CB Fail Detection of a Circuit Breaker failure (CB not open at the end
of tBF timer)
tI2> Time delayed negative phase sequence (1st threshold)
Input 1 Copy of the state of the Logic Input n°1
Input 2 Copy of the state of the Logic Input n°2
Input 3 Copy of the state of the Logic Input n°3
Input 4 Copy of the state of the Logic Input n°4
Input 5 Copy of the state of the Logic Input n°5
Recloser Run Auto-recloser function in progress
Recloser Blocked Auto-recloser function locked
t Aux 1 Copy of the state of the Logic Input delayed by t Aux 1
t Aux 2 Copy of the state of the Logic Input delayed by t Aux 2
tI2>> Time delayed negative phase sequence (2nd threshold)
Led Therm. Displays the thermal threshold tIθ trip order associated
Trip No with
LED 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Brkn. Cond Displays the broken conductor information associated with
Yes LED 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led CB Fail Displays the circuit breaker failure information associated
Yes with LED 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using #
scroll through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Input 1 Displays the state of the logic input 1 associated with LED
No 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Input 2 Displays the state of the logic input 2 associated with LED
Yes 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Input 3 Displays the state of the logic input 3 associated with LED
No 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led t Aux 1 Displays the state of the logic input delayed by t Aux 1. To
Yes modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll through
the available selections.
Led t Aux 2 Displays the state of the logic input delayed by t Aux 2. To
No modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll through
the available selections.
Led tI2> Displays the negative phase sequence 1st threshold tI2>
No associated with LED 5. To modify this choice, press '
and using # scroll through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led tI2>> Displays the negative phase sequence 2nd threshold tI2>>
No associated with LED 5. To modify this choice, press '
and using # scroll through the available selections.
To this LED. Enable your choice using '.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Led Input 4 Displays the state of the logic input 4 associated with LED
No 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Input 5 Displays the state of the logic input 5 associated with LED
No 5. To modify this choice, press ' and using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Led Recloser Displays the state of the auto-recloser function (running or
Run No not) associated with LED 5. To modify this choice, press
' and using # scroll through the available selections.
To this LED. Enable your choice using '.
Led Recloser Displays the state of the auto-recloser function (locked or
Blocked No free) associated with LED 5. To modify this choice, press
' and using # scroll through the available selections.
To this LED. Enable your choice using '.
Change Group Displays the operation mode of the digital input associated
Input = EDGE to the change of group of protection : "EDGE" or "LEVEL".
To change the operation mode, press ' then using #
scroll through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Setting Group Displays of the active setting group (1 or 2). To change
1 the active setting group, press ' then using # enter the
required value (1 or 2).
Enable your choice using '.
This window will disappear if the change group input
choice is LEVEL.
Inst. Self-reset ? Displays the reset mode of the alarms concerning the
No instantaneous : self-reset Yes or No. If the user chooses
No, the reset will be done by push button.
To change the reset mode press ' then using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Reset led on Displays the reset mode of the alarms concerning the
fault ? No instantaneous :reset led on a new fault Yes or No.
To change the reset mode press ' then using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
The user has to set in the CONFIGURATION Menu the auxiliary voltage (AC or DC) for the
operation of the digital inputs. This setting is necessary due to the time filtering different in
DC and AC.
NOTE : If the V4 or V5 software is used with a V3 hardware the setting must
be DC.
Inputs 54321 Displays the operation of the digital Inputs either on falling
10110 edge/low level, or on rising edge/high level.
0 = falling edge/low level
1 = rising edge/high level
To change the operation mode press ' then using #
scroll through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Voltage input Displays the voltage (AC or DC) on the digital Inputs.
DC To change the voltage press ' then using # scroll
through the available selections.
Enable your choice using '.
Max & Average I Allows the user to clear the maximum (peak) and average
RST = [C] (rolling) memorised values of the current.
To clear these values, press ! (password needed).
Max IA Rms Display the peak value for phase A. The value is the true
127.36 A RMS maximum value.
Max IB Rms Display the peak value for phase B. The value is the true
156.28 A RMS maximum value.
Max IC Rms Display the peak value for phase C. The value is the true
139.01 A RMS maximum value.
Average IA Rms Display the rolling value for phase A. The value is the true
98.25 A RMS average value.
Average IB Rms Display the rolling value for phase B. The value is the true
97.88 A RMS average value.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Average IC Rms Display the rolling value for phase C. The value is the true
99.02 A RMS average value.
MAX. SUBPERIOD Allows the user to clear the maximum subperiod values of
RST = [C] the 3 currents.
MAX. SUBPERIOD Display the IA peak value demand. The value is the true
IA Rms = 245A RMS maximum value on a subperiod.
MAX. SUBPERIOD Display the IB peak value demand. The value is the true
IB Rms = 240A RMS maximum value on a subperiod.
MAX. SUBPERIOD Display the IC peak value demand. The value is the true
IC Rms = 250A RMS maximum value on a subperiod.
ROLLING AVERAGE Allows the user to clear the rolling average values of the 3
RST = [C] currents.
ROLLING AVERAGE Display the IA average value demand. The value is the
IA Rms = 0A true RMS average value on a number of subperiod set in
Record menu.
ROLLING AVERAGE Display the IB average value demand. The value is the
IB Rms = 0A true RMS average value on a number of subperiod set in
Record menu.
ROLLING AVERAGE Display the IC average value demand. The value is the
IC Rms = 0A true RMS average value on a number of subperiod set in
Record menu.
Reclose Stats Allows the user to clear the reclosing statistics. To clear
RST = [C] these values, press ! (password needed).
Total Trip & Display the total number of definitive trips issued from the
Lockout 2 autorecloser.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
Stop Bits Display of the number of stop bits in the MODBUS frame.
1 Select 0 or 1 using # and enable your choice using '.
Relay Address Display of the network address of the MiCOM relay in the
29 MODBUS network. Select from 1 to 255 using # and
enable your choice using '.
Date format Display the format of the date, either PRIVATE or IEC
Private protocol.
WARNING : A MODBUS NETWORK CAN ONLY COMPRISE 32 RELAY ADDRESSES
ON THE SAME MODBUS SUB-LAN.
3.5.4.2 Courier COMMUNICATION Menu
Relay Address Display of the network address of the MiCOM relay in the
29 IEC 60870-5-103 network. Select from 1 to 255 using #
and enable your choice using the key '.
Stop Bits Display of the number of stop bits in the MODBUS frame.
1 Select 0 or 1 using # and enable your choice using '.
Relay Address Display of the network address of the MiCOM relay in the
29 MODBUS network. Select from 1 to 255 using # and
enable your choice using '.
tI > Selection of the I> time delay. Select the time delay from 0
100 ms to 150 s using # and enable your choice using '.
Delay Type Display the I> inverse time delay (IEC or IEEE/ANSI
IDMT curves).
Idmt Selection of the I> curve. Select from IEC SI, IEC STI, IEC
IEC SI VI, IEC EI, IEC LTI, CO2, IEEE MI, CO8, IEEE VI, IEEE EI
using # and enable your choice using the key '.
Tms Select the curve TMS value. Select from 0.025 to 1.5
0,025 using # and enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.1.2.1 P122 & P123 additional I> DMT reset time, IEC curves menu
3.5.5.1.2.2 P122 & P123 additional I> DMT reset time, ANSI curves menu
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset DMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and enable your choice using '.
t Reset Selection of the t Reset value associated with the DMT
40 ms reset time choice. Select from 40 ms to 100 s using #
and enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.1.2.3 P122 & P123 additional I> IDMT reset time, ANSI curves menu
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset IDMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and enable your choice using '.
Rtms Selection of the Rtms value associated with the IDMT
0.025 reset time choice. Select from 0.025 to 1.5 using # and
enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.1.3.1 P122 & P123 additional I> DMT reset time, Electromechanical RI curves menu
Delay Type Selection of the Ie> threshold time delay type. Select
DMT (DMT for definite time, IDMT for inverse time curves, RI
for the electromechanical inverse time curve, LABOR. for
Laborelec inverse curves) using # and enable your
choice using '.
tIe > Selection of the Ie> time delay. Select the time delay from
100 ms 0 to 150 s using # and enable your choice using '.
Delay Type Display of the Ie> inverse time delay (IEC or IEEE/ANSI
DMT curves).
Idmt Selection of the Ie> curve. Select from IEC SI, IEC STI,
IEC SI IEC VI, IEC EI, IEC LTI, CO2, IEEE MI, CO8, IEEE VI,
IEEE EI using # and enable your choice using the key
'.
Tms Selection of the selected curve Tms value. Select from
0,025 0.025 to 1.5 using # and enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.2.2.1 P122 & P123 additional Ie> DMT reset time, IEC curves menu
3.5.5.2.2.2 P122 & P123 additional Ie> DMT reset time, ANSI curves menu
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset DMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and enable your choice using '.
t Reset Selection of the t Reset value associated with the DMT
40 ms reset time choice. Select from 40 ms to 100 s using #
and enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.2.2.3 P122 & P123 additional Ie> IDMT reset time, ANSI curves menu
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset IDMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and enable your choice using '.
Rtms Selection of the Rtms value associated with the IDMT
0.025 reset time choice. Select from 0.025 to 1.5 using # and
enable your choice using '.
3.5.5.2.3.1 P122 & P123 additional Ie> DMT reset time, RI curves menu
3.5.5.3 [46] NEGATIVE Phase SEQUENCE I2> sub-menu (P122 & P123 only)
Delay Type Selection of the I2> threshold time delay type. Select
DMT (DMT for independent time, IDMT for inverse time curves,
RI for the electromechanical inverse time curve) using #
and validate your choice using '.
t I2 > Selection of the I2> time delay. Select the time delay from
100 ms 0 to 150 s using # and validate your choice using '.
Delay Type Display of the I2> inverse time delay (IEC or IEEE/ANSI
IDMT curves).
Curve Selection of the I2> curve. Select from IEC SI, IEC STI,
IEC SI IEC VI, IEC EI, IEC LTI, CO2, IEEE MI, CO8, IEEE VI,
IEEE EI using # and validate your choice using the key
'.
Tms Selection of the selected curve Tms value. Select from
0,025 0.025 to 1.5 using # and validate your choice using '.
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset DMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and validate your choice using '.
t Reset Selection of the t Reset value associated with the DMT
40 ms reset time choice. Select from 40 ms to 100 s using #
and validate your choice using '.
Type Tempo Selection of the type of reset time delay. Select between
Reset IDMT DMT (Definitive Time) and IDMT (Inverse Time) using #
and validate your choice using '.
Rtms Selection of the Rtms value associated with the IDMT
0.025 reset time choice. Select from 0.025 to 1.5 using # and
validate your choice using '.
Ext CB Fail Allows the use of a dedicated input (CB FLT) to inform the
Yes autorecloser function of the state (failure or operational) of
the CB.
Ext CB Fail Time Selection of the external CB failure time delay tCFE.
10000 ms Select the time delay from 10 ms to 600 s using # and
validate your choice using '.
Ext Block ? Allows the use of a dedicated input (Block_79) to block the
Yes autorecloser function.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Dead Time Selection of the First Cycle Dead Time (tD1) value
tD1 60 ms associated with the autoreclose function. Select from
10 ms to 300 s step of 10 ms using # and validate your
choice using '.
Dead Time Selection of the Second Cycle Dead Time (tD2) value
tD2 100 ms associated with the autoreclose function. Select from
10 ms to 300 s step of 10 ms using # and validate your
choice using '.
Dead Time Selection of the Third Cycle Dead Time (tD3) value
tD3 200 ms associated with the autoreclose function. Select from
10 ms to 600 s step of 10 ms using # and validate your
choice using '.
Dead Time Selection of the Fourth Cycle Dead Time (tD4) value
tD4 60 ms associated with the autoreclose function. Select from
10 ms to 600 step of 10 ms using # and validate your
choice using '.
Reclaim Time Selection of the Reclaim Time (tR) value associated with
tR 120 ms the autoreclose function. Select from 20 ms to 600 s step
of 10 ms using # and validate your choice using '
Inhib Time Selection of the Inhibit Time (tI) value associated with the
tI 120 ms autoreclose function (following a manual CB closure).
Select from 20 ms to 600 s step of 10 ms using # and
validate your choice using ' your choice
⇒ Trip Commands
⇒ Latch of the trip output relay RL1 by function (P121, P122, P123 only)
⇒ Outputs Relays
⇒ Inputs
Trip tI < Allocation of the minimum current threshold (I<) to the trip
No output. This information is generated is less than a cycle
of the network frequency (50 or 60 Hz).
Select Yes or No.
Select Yes or No.
Trip tI2 > Allocation of the delayed negative phase sequence
No overcurrent threshold (tI2>) to the trip output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip tI2 >> Allocation of the delayed negative phase sequence
No overcurrent threshold (tI2>>) to the trip output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip Thermal θ Allocation of the thermal overload Trip information (θTrip)
No to the trip output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip Brkn.Cond Allocation of the broken conductor detection to the trip
Yes output.
Select Yes or No.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
Trip t Aux 1 Allocation of the delayed auxiliary input Aux 1 to the trip
No output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip t Aux 2 Allocation of the delayed auxiliary input Aux 2 to the trip
No output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip t Aux 3 Allocation of the delayed auxiliary input Aux 3 to the trip
No output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip CB Fail Allocation of the Breaker failure information to the trip
No output.
Select Yes or No.
Trip t Aux 4 Allocation of the delayed auxiliary input Aux 4 to the trip
No output.
Select Yes or No.
3.5.6.2 Latch of trip output relay by Function Sub-Menu (P121, P122 & P123 relays)
This sub-menu makes it possible to latch the trip output relay RL1 associated with one or
several thresholds/functions after the cause has disappeared.
Latch tI> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the first
Yes phase time delay overcurrent threshold (tI>) (select Yes or
No). If the user validates Yes, RL1 shall be latched after
tI> disappeared. If the user validates No, RL1 shall drop
out after tI> disappeared.
Latch tI>> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
Yes second phase time delay overcurrent threshold (tI>>)
Select Yes or No.
Latch tI>>> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the third
No phase time delay overcurrent threshold (tI>>>)
Select Yes or No.
Latch tIe> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the first
No earth time delay overcurrent threshold (tIe>)
Select Yes or No.
Latch tIe>> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No second earth time delay overcurrent threshold (tIe>>)
Select Yes or No.
Latch tIe>>> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the third
No earth time delay overcurrent threshold (tIe>>>)
Select Yes or No.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Latch tI < Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the time
Yes delay minimum current threshold (tI<).
Select Yes or No.
Latch tI2 > Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the time
No delay negative phase sequence overcurrent threshold
(tI2>) to the trip output. Select Yes or No.
Select Yes or No.
Latch tI2 >> Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the time
No delay negative phase sequence overcurrent threshold
(tI2>>) to the trip output. Select Yes or No.
Select Yes or No.
Latch Thermal θ Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No thermal overload Trip information (θ Trip).
Select Yes or No.
Latch Brkn.Cond Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No broken conductor function.
Select Yes or No.
Latch t Aux 1 Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No delayed auxiliary input Aux 1.
Select Yes or No.
Latch t Aux 2 Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No delayed auxiliary input Aux 2.
Select Yes or No.
Latch t Aux 3 Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No delayed auxiliary input Aux 3.
Select Yes or No.
Latch t Aux 4 Latch of the trip output relay RL1 associated with the
No delayed auxiliary input Aux 4.
Select Yes or No.
Latch tI> Latch of the output relay(s) associated with the first phase
Yes (or earth) time delay overcurrent threshold tI> (tIe>).
If the user validates Yes, all output relay(s) associated
with tI> (tIe>) threshold shall be latched after tI> (tIe>).
If the user validates No, the output relay(s) associated
with tI> (tIe>) shall drop out after tI> (tIe>) disappeared.
Latch tI>> Latch of the output relay(s) associated with the first phase
Yes (or earth) time delay overcurrent threshold tI>> (tIe>>).
If the user validates Yes, all output relay(s) associated
with tI>> (tIe>>) threshold shall be latched after tI>>
(tIe>>).
If the user validates No, the output relay(s) associated
with tI>> (tIe>>) shall drop out after tI>> (tIe>>)
disappeared.
Latch tI>>> Latch of the output relay(s) associated with the first phase
Yes (or earth) time delay overcurrent threshold tI>>> (tIe>>>).
If the user validates Yes, all output relay(s) associated
with tI>>> (tIe>>>) threshold shall be latched after tI>>>
(tIe>>>).
If the user validates No, the output relay(s) associated
with tI>>> (tIe>>>) shall drop out after tI>>> (tIe>>>)
disappeared.
Block tI> Blocking logic of the first phase time delay overcurrent
Yes threshold (tI>) (select Yes or No). If the user validates
Yes, the first threshold shall be locked on the transition
(logic state 1) of the Logic "Blk log" logic input. If the user
validates No, the transition of the "Blk log" logic input shall
not alter the first phase threshold tI>.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Block tI>> Blocking logic of the second phase time delay overcurrent
Yes threshold (tI>>).
Select Yes or No.
Block tI>>> Blocking logic of the third phase time delay overcurrent
Yes threshold (tI>>>)
Select Yes or No.
Block tIe> Blocking logic of the first earth time delay overcurrent
No threshold (tIe>).
Select Yes or No.
Block tIe>> Blocking logic of the second earth time delay overcurrent
No threshold (tIe>>).
Select Yes or No.
Block tIe>>> Blocking logic of the third earth time delay overcurrent
No threshold (tIe>>>).
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 tI2 > Blocking logic of the time delay negative phase sequence
No overcurrent threshold (tI2>) to the trip output.
Select Yes or No.
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 tI2 >> Blocking logic of the time delay negative phase sequence
No overcurrent threshold (tI2>>) to the trip output.
Select Yes or No.
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 Thermal θ Blocking logic of the thermal state calculation.
Yes Select Yes or No.
Block 1 Brkn.Cond Blocking logic of the broken conductor function
No Select Yes or No.
Block 1 t Aux 1 Blocking logic of the time delay of the auxiliary input Aux
No 1.
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 t Aux 2 Blocking logic of the time delay of the auxiliary input Aux
No 2.
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 t Aux 3 Blocking logic of the time delay of the auxiliary input Aux
No 3.
Select Yes or No.
Block 1 t Aux 4 Blocking logic of the time delay of the auxiliary input Aux
No 4.
Select Yes or No.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
Trip 8765432 Allocation of trip orders to the output relays (copies the trip
1100010 contact onto one or several selected relays).
To allocate this information to the output relay(s), press
', then allocate to the desired output relay the value
1using #. Repeat the operation on the other output relays
if desired, then validate using '.
I> 8765432 Allocation of the first phase instantaneous overcurrent
1100010 threshold (I>) to the output relays .
Select output relays.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Aux4 Time Displays the time delay t Aux 4 associated with the logic
t Aux4 100s input Aux 4. To modify this value, press '.
The t Aux 4 is adjustable from 0 ms to 200 s by step of
10 ms, then validate your choice using '.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
Cold Load PU ? Selection of the cold load pick-up function. Select Yes or
Yes No. If the user validates (Yes), the following menu is
displayed. If the user does not validate (No), the cold load
pick-up function is inactive.
Cold Load PU Associate the I> time delay threshold with the cold load
tI> ? No pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick-up
function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Associate the I>> time delay threshold with the cold load
tI>> ? Yes pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick up
function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Associated the I>>> time delay threshold to the cold load
tI>>> ? Yes pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick up
function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Associated the Ie> time delay threshold to the cold load
tIe> ? Yes pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick-up
function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Associated the Ie>> time delay threshold to the cold load
tIe>> ? Yes pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick-up
function. Validate your choice using '.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Cold Load PU Associated the Ie>>> time delay threshold to the cold load
tIe>>> ? Yes pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate the desired threshold to the cold load pick-up
function. Validate your choice using '.
COLD LOAD P/UP Associated the I2> time delay threshold the cold load pick
tI2> Yes up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using #
allocate desired threshold to the cold load start pick up
function. Validate your choice using '.
COLD LOAD P/UP Associated the I2>> time delay threshold the cold load
tI2>> No pick up function. To modify this choice, press ' and using
# allocate desired threshold to the cold load start pick up
function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Associated the Thermal overload time delay threshold to
t Therm. ? Yes the cold load pick up function. To modify this choice, press
' and using # allocate the desired threshold to the cold
load pick-up function. Validate your choice using '.
Cold Load PU Selection of the cold load pick up percentage scaling
level 200 % value associated with the selected thresholds. Select from
20% to 500% with steps of 1 % using # and validate your
choice using '.
Cold Load PU Selection of the cold load pick up time delay. Select from
tCL = 400 ms 100 ms to 3600 s with steps of 10 ms using # and
validate your choice using '.
t Open Pulse Selection of the tripping pulse time. Select from 100 ms to
100 ms 5 s with steps of 100 ms using # and validate your choice
using '.
t Close Pulse Selection of the closing time. Select from 100 ms to 5 s
100 ms with steps of 100 ms using # and validate your choice
using '.
Comm. Ord. Latch Heading of the Comm. Ord. Latch Times sub-menu.
Times To gain access to the sub-menu points, press $.
NOTE : This sub-menu is visible if at least a
communication order is assigned to an output
relay.
t Comm 1 Selection of the t Comm 1 pulse time.
100 ms Select from 0.1 s to 5 s with steps of 0.05 s using # and
validate your choice using '.
t Comm 2 Selection of the t Comm 2 pulse time.
150 ms Select from 0.1 s to 5 s with steps of 0.05 s using # and
validate your choice using '.
t Comm 3 Selection of the t Comm 3 pulse time.
5s Select from 0.1 s to 5 s with steps of 0.05 s using # and
validate your choice using '.
t Comm 4 Selection of the t Comm 4 pulse time.
1s Select from 0.1 s to 5 s with steps of 0.05 s using # and
validate your choice using '.
⇒ CB Monitoring
⇒ fault record
⇒ Instantaneous
⇒ Disturb record
⇒ Time peak value
⇒ Rolling demand
To gain access to the RECORDING menu, press # then % 7 times.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
Σ Amps (n) IB Display the summation of the Amps (or square Amps)
2 E4 interrupted by the circuit breaker phase B
Σ Amps (n) IC Display the summation of the Amps (or square Amps)
8 E3 interrupted by the circuit breaker phase C
Faulted Phase Display the faulty phase for the chosen fault record.
Phase A (NONE, phase A, B, C, EARTH, AB, AC, BC, or ABC).
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
Threshold Display the origin of the fault that as generated the trip
I>> order.
Disturb Rec Trig Selection of start criteria for the disturbance recording
ON INST. function. Select between ON INST. (start on
instantaneous thresholds) or ON Trip (start on trip
conditions) using # and validate your choice using '.
Time Window Selection of the time of the window during the peak and
5 mn average values are stored. Select either 5mn, 10mn,
15mn, 30mn, or 60mn using # and validate your choice
using '.
Sub period Selection of the width of the sub-period during the rolling
1 mn average values are calculated. Select from 1 mn to 60 mn
with step of 1 mn using # and validate your choice using
'.
Num of Sub Per Selection of number of sub-period for the calculation of the
1 average of these average values.
P12x/EN FT/F65 User Guide
4. WIRING
The relays of the MiCOM P120 range have the same cable layout (for common elements).
The cabling layouts of each model are provided in Appendix 1 to this Technical Guide.
4.1 Auxiliary supply
The electric auxiliary supply of the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays can be either
continuous (range 24-60 Vdc, 48-150 Vdc, 130-250 Vdc) or alternative (100-250 Vac/ 50-60
Hz). The voltage range is specified on the relay data plate under the upper flap on the front
face.
Supply must only be connected to terminals 33 and 34.
4.2 Current measurement inputs
The MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays may comprise up to eight current inputs
(2 times 4 earth and phase current inputs).
The nominal current value of these measuring inputs is either 1 Ampere or 5 Amperes (as
per cabling layout). For the same relay, the user can mix the 1 and 5 Ampere inputs between
phases and earth.
NOTE : All two or three phase inputs must have the same value (1 or 5 Amps)
4.3 Logic inputs
MiCOM P123 relays have 5 opto-isolated logic inputs (3 logic inputs for P122, 2 for P120
and P121) Each input has its own independent polarity.
The voltage range of the inputs is identical to the dc or ac auxiliary supply range of the
MiCOM relay (e.g. Uaux = 48-150 Vdc, logic input voltage range = 48-150 Vdc).
On the same MiCOM P12x relay, the user can mixed different voltage level for the logic
inputs (e.g. Uaux = 48-150 Vdc, Input 1= 48 Vdc, Input 2-5= 110 Vdc)
The automation operations and signalling functions to which these logic inputs respond can
be selected by means of the AUTOMAT. CTRL Menu.
NOTE : Do not forget to select in the CONFIGURATION/Configuration Inputs
Menu if the voltage input is "AC" or "DC".
4.4 Output relays
Nine output relays are available on MiCOM P123 (7 output relays for P122 and 5 for P121
and P120).
8 relays are freely programmable (6 for P122, 4 for P121 & P120).
The first relay with change over contact (RL0) being allocated to signalling an equipment
fault (WATCH DOG).
The second and third relays (RL1, RL2) are of change-over relays (1 common, 1 normally
open contact, 1 normally closed contact).
The other relays (RL3, to RL 9) are normally open-type relays (1 common, 1 open contact).
The protection and control functions to which these relays respond can be selected by
means of the AUTOMAT. CTRL. Menu.
User Guide P12x/EN FT/F65
4.5 Communication
BLANK PAGE
Menu Content Tables P12x/EN HI/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CONTENTS
BLANK PAGE
1.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IL1 = 1245 A
Relay 4321
Status 1011
Page 3/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IL1 = 1245 A
Page 4/32
[50/51] Phase OC Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic Output Relays Inputs 1/2
Idmt
IEC SI
Tms
0.025
I>> ?
Yes
I>>
2.0 In
MiCOM P120 - V4 Software
t I>>
300 ms Menu content
I>>> ?
Yes
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
2.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IL1 = 1245 A
tI>>> Y/N
Ie> Y/N
Software version E/Gnd CT primary tIe> Y/N IL3 Stop bits Delay Type I>>>
5.D 1000 Ie>> Y/N 257.50 A 1 IDMT 10.0 In
MiCOM P121 – V5 SOFTWARE
tIe>> Y/N
Ie>>> Y/N
Frequency E/Gnd CT sec tIe>>> Y/N IN Relay Address Idmt t I>>>
50 Hz 1 20.00 A 12 IEC SI 110 ms
Input 21 Tms
Status 01 0.025
I>> ?
Yes
I>>
2.0 In
Page 5/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IL1 = 1245 A
Page 6/32
[50N/51N] E/Gnd Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic Output Relays
Ie >> ?
Yes
Ie >>
0.01 Ien
Delay Type
DMT
t Ie >>
300 ms MiCOM P121 - V5 Software
Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IL1 = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Output 2 None
No
Unlatch
52 a
Output 3 52 b
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Yes CB FLT
Aux 1
Aux 2
Output 4 Blk Log
No
Page 7/32
3.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
Page 8/32
OP PARAMETERS CONFIGURATION
P12x/EN HI/F65
Password
Display CT Ratio Led 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 Group Select Alarms Inputs
****
Description Default Display Line CT primary Led Change Group Inst. Self-reset ? Inputs : 321
P122-1 RMS I A 1000 I> Y/N INPUT = EDGE No 001
tI> Y/N
l>> Y/N
Reference Phase A Text Line CT sec tI>> Y/N Setting Group Reset led on Voltage input =
ALST A 1 I>>> Y/N 1 fault? No DC
tI>>> Y/N
Ie> Y/N
Software version Phase B Text E/Gnd CT primary tIe> Y/N Alarm Battery =
5.F B 1000 Ie>> Y/N No
MiCOM P122 – V5 SOFTWARE
tIe>> Y/N
Ie>>> Y/N
Frequency Phase C Text E/Gnd CT sec tIe>>> Y/N
50 Hz C 1 Therm Trip Y/N
Brkn. Cond Y/N
CB Fail Y/N
Active Group = E/Gnd Text tI2> Y/N
1 N tI2>> Y/N
Input 1 Y/N
Input 2 Y/N
Input 321 Input 3 Y/N
Status 101 tAux 1 Y/N
tAux 2 Y/N
Relay 654321
Status 001011
Date
14/08/02
Time
MiCOM P122 - V5 Software
13 : 15 : 33
Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
CONFIGURATION MEASUREMENTS COMMUNICATION
G1/G2
Maintenance Mode Phase rotation = 257.05 A 0.00 A Baud Rate Yes Yes
oui A-B-C 19200 Bd
IB Average IA RMS = I> I>>>
258.80 A 150 A 0.1 In 10.0 In
RELAYS 65W4321 Parity
CMD 0000000 None
IC Average IB RMS = Delay Type t I>>>
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
ROLLING AVERAGE
MiCOM P122 - V5 Software
I C RMS= 0.00 A
Menu content
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 9/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
Page 10/32
G1/G2
P12x/EN HI/F65
Ie > I2 >
Iθ> I<
0.01 Ien Ie >>> ? 0.1 In
0.1 In 0.2 In
Yes
Delay Type Delay Type
INV IDMT Te tI <
Ie >>>
1 mn 200 ms
1.0 Ien
Idmt Curve
IEC SI IEC SI k
t Ie >>>
1.05
300 ms
Tms Tms
0.025 0.025 θ Trip
100 %
t Reset t Reset
60 ms 60 ms θ Alarm ?
Yes
Ie >> ? I2 >> ?
Yes Yes θ Alarm
100 %
Ie >> I2 >>
0.01 Ien 0.5 In
t Ie >>
300 ms
MiCOM P122
V5 Software - Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic 1/2 Logic Select 1/2 Output Relays
Page 11/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Page 12/32
Comm.Ord. Latch
Latch Output Relays Inputs 1/2/3 Broken Conductor Cold Load PU CB Fail CB Supervision times
P12x/EN HI/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
RECORDS
CB Monitoring Fault Record Instantaneous Disturb Record Time Peak Value Rolling Demand
Menu Content Tables
CB Opening Time Record Number Number Pre-Time Time Window Sub Period
83 ms 4 5 1.3 s 5 mn 1mn
IA Magnitude
1200 A MiCOM P122 - V5 Software
IB Magnitude Menu content
500 A
IC Magnitude
480 A
IN Magnitude
103 A
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 13/32
4.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
OP PARAMETERS CONFIGURATION
Page 14/32
P12x/EN HI/F65
Password
Display CT Ratio LED 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 Group Select Alarms Inputs
****
Description Default Display Line CT primary Led Change Group Inst. Self-reset ? Inputs : 54321
P123-1 RMS I A 1000 I> Y/N Input = EDGE No 00001
tI> Y/N
l>> Y/N
Reference Phase A Text Line CT sec tI>> Y/N Setting Group Reset led on Voltage input =
ALST A 1 I>>> Y/N 1 fault? No DC
tI>>> Y/N
Ie> Y/N
Software version Phase B Text E/Gnd CT primary tIe> Y/N Alarm Battery =
5.F B 1000 Ie>> Y/N No
MiCOM P123 – V5 SOFTWARE
tIe>> Y/N
Ie>>> Y/N
Frequency Phase C Text E/Gnd CT sec tIe>>> Y/N
50 Hz C 1 Therm Trip Y/N
Brkn. Cond Y/N
CB Fail Y/N
Active Group = E/Gnd Text tI2> Y/N
1 N Input 1 Y/N
Input 2 Y/N
Input 3 Y/N
Input 54321 Input 4 Y/N
Status 00101 Input 5 Y/N
Recloser Run Y/N
Recloser Blocked Y/N
Relay 87654321 tAux 1 Y/N
Status 00001011 tAux 2 Y/N
tI2>> Y/N
Date
14/08/02
Time
MiCOM P123 - V5 Software
14 : 15 : 34 Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
CONFIGURATION MEASUREMENTS COMMUNICATION
G1/G2
Maintenance Mode Phase rotation = IA Max IC RMS = Reclose Stats Baud Rate I>?
oui A-B-C 257.05 A 0.00 A RST = [C] 19200 Bd Yes
Menu Content Tables
I>>>
10.0 In
t I>>>
MiCOM P123 - V5 Software - Menu content 110 ms
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 15/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
G1/G2
Page 16/32
P12x/EN HI/F65
[50N/51N] E/Gnd [46] Neg Seq OC [49] Therm OL [37] Undercurrent [79] Autoreclose
t Ie >>
300 ms
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic 1/2 Logic Select 1/2 Output Relays
Yes
1000100
No Yes
I>
Trip tI >> Latch tI >> Block 1 tI >> Sel 1 tI >>> tl >
Yes Trip tAux 1 Yes Latch tAux 1 Yes Yes I >>
Yes Yes tl >>
Trip tI >>> Latch tI >>> Block 1 tI >>> Sel1 tle >> I >>>
Trip tAux 2 Latch tAux 2
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Page 17/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Page 18/32
Relays times
Aux3 Time
Cold Load PU ΣAmps (n) tOpen Pulse
tAux3 300 ms tTherm ? Yes 3 E6 300ms
Cold Load PU
MiCOM P123 - V5 Software - Menu content tCL 2s
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
RECORDS
CB Monitoring Fault Record Instantaneous Disturb Record Time Peak Value Rolling Demand
Menu Content Tables
CB Opening Time Record Number Number Pre-Time Time Window Sub Period
83 ms 4 5 1.3 s 5 mn 1mn
IA Magnitude
1200 A
IB Magnitude
MiCOM P123 V5 Software
500 A
Menu content
IC Magnitude
480 A
IN Magnitude
103 A
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 19/32
5.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
OP PARAMETERS CONFIGURATION
Page 20/32
P12x/EN HI/F65
Password
Display CT Ratio LED 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 Group Select Alarms Inputs
****
Description Default Display Line CT primary Led Change Group Inst. Self-reset ? Inputs : 321
P122-1 RMS I A 1000 I> Y/N Input = EDGE No 001
tI> Y/N
l>> Y/N
Reference Phase A Text Line CT sec tI>> Y/N Setting Group Reset led on Voltage input =
ALST A 1 I>>> Y/N 1 fault? No DC
tI>>> Y/N
Ie> Y/N
Software version Phase B Text E/Gnd CT primary tIe> Y/N Alarm Battery =
5.D B 1000 Ie>> Y/N No
MiCOM P122 – V6 SOFTWARE
tIe>> Y/N
Ie>>> Y/N
Frequency Phase C Text E/Gnd CT sec tIe>>> Y/N
50 Hz C 1 Therm Trip Y/N
Brkn. Cond Y/N
CB Fail Y/N
Active Group = E/Gnd Text tI2> Y/N
1 N tI2>> Y/N
Input 1 Y/N
Input 2 Y/N
Input 321 Input 3 Y/N
Status 101 tAux 1 Y/N
tAux 2 Y/N
Relay 654321
Status 001011
Date
04/03/02
Time
MiCOM P122 - V6 Software
14 : 15 : 34
Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
A-B-C
257.50 A 148 A 1
IN - fn = MAX. SUBPERIOD
RST = [C] 0.00A I C RMS=254.1 A
Page 21/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
G1/G2
Page 22/32
[50/51] Phase OC [50N/51N] E/Gnd [46] Neg Seq OC [49] Therm OL [37] Undercurrent
P12x/EN HI/F65
I>>> ?
I> Ie > I2 > Iθ> I<
Yes
0.1 In 0.01 Ien 0.1 In 0.1 In 0.2 In
Ie >>> ?
Yes
Delay Type I>>> sample
Delay Type Delay Type Te tI <
IDMT Yes
IDMT IDMT 1 mn 200 ms
Ie >>> sample
I>>> Yes
Idmt Idmt Curve k
IEC SI 10.0 In
IEC SI IEC SI 1.05
Ie >>>
Tms t I>>> 1.0 Ien
110 ms Tms Tms θ Trip
0.025
0.025 0.025 100 %
t Ie >>>
tReset 300 ms
t Reset t Reset θ Alarm ?
60 ms
60 ms 60 ms Yes
I>> ?
Ie >> ? I2>> ? θ Alarm
Yes
Yes Yes 100 %
I>>
2.0 In Ie >> I2>>
0.01 Ien 0.5 In
Delay Type
DMT Delay Type t I2>>
DMT 110 ms
t I>>
300 ms
t Ie >>
300 ms
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic 1/2 Logic Select 1/2 Output Relays
00100
No Yes I>
Trip tI >> Latch tI >> Block 1 tI >> Sel 1 tI >>> tl >
Yes Trip tAux 1 Yes Latch tAux 1 Yes Yes I >>
Yes Yes tl >>
Trip tI >>> Latch tI >>> Block 1 tI >>> Sel1 tle >> I >>>
Trip tAux 2 tl >>>
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Page 23/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Page 24/32
Latch Output
Inputs 1/2/3 Broken Conductor Cold Load PU CB Fail CB Supervision
P12x/EN HI/F65
Relays
Cold Load PU n
Level 120 % 2
Cold Load PU
tCL 2s
MiCOM P122 - V6 Software - Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
RECORDS
CB Monitoring Fault Record Instantaneous Disturb Record Time Peak Value Rolling Demand
Menu Content Tables
CB Opening Time Record Number Number Pre-Time Time Window Sub Period
83 ms 4 5 1.3 s 5 mn 1mn
IA Magnitude
1200 A
IB Magnitude
MiCOM P122 - V6 Software -
500 A
IC Magnitude
Menu content
480 A
IN Magnitude
103 A
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 25/32
6.
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
OP PARAMETERS CONFIGURATION
Page 26/32
P12x/EN HI/F65
Password
Display CT Ratio LED 5 / 6 / 7 / 8 Group Select Alarms Inputs
****
Description Default Display Line CT primary Led Change Group Inst. Self-reset ? Inputs : 54321
P123-1 RMS I A 1000 I> Y/N Input = EDGE No 00001
tI> Y/N
l>> Y/N
Reference Phase A Text Line CT sec tI>> Y/N Setting Group Reset led on Voltage input =
ALST A 1 I>>> Y/N 1 fault? No DC
tI>>> Y/N
Ie> Y/N
Software version Phase B Text E/Gnd CT primary tIe> Y/N Alarm Battery =
5.D B 1000 Ie>> Y/N No
MiCOM P123 – V6 SOFTWARE
tIe>> Y/N
Ie>>> Y/N
Frequency Phase C Text E/Gnd CT sec tIe>>> Y/N
50 Hz C 1 Therm Trip Y/N
Brkn. Cond Y/N
CB Fail Y/N
Active Group = E/Gnd Text tI2> Y/N
1 N tI2>> Y/N
Input 1 Y/N
Input 2 Y/N
Input 54321 Input 3 Y/N
Status 00101 Input 4 Y/N
Input 5 Y/N
Recloser Run Y/N
Relay 87654321 Recloser Blocked Y/N
Status 00001011 tAux 1 Y/N
tAux 2 Y/N
Date
04/03/02
Time
MiCOM P123 - V6 Software
14 : 15 : 34
Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
CONFIGURATION MEASUREMENTS COMMUNICATION
G1/G2
Maintenance Mode Phase rotation = IA Max IC RMS = Reclose Stats Baud Rate I>?
Yes A-B-C 257.05 A 0.00 A RST = [C] 19200 Bd Yes
Menu Content Tables
Tms
I1= MAX. SUBPERIOD Cycle 3 Recloses Date format =
0.025
103 A RST =[C] 0 PRIVATE
tReset
I2= MAX. SUBPERIOD Cycle 4 Recloses
60 ms
50 A I A RMS=254.2 A 0
I>> ?
RATIO I 2 / I 1 = MAX. SUBPERIOD Total Trip &
Yes
50 % I B RMS=254.2 A Lockout 0
I>>
IN - fn = MAX. SUBPERIOD 2.0 In
RST = [C] 0.00A I C RMS=254.1 A
Delay Type
Thermal θ ROLLING AVERAGE DMT
RST = [C] 0% RST=[C]
t I>>
Max & Average I ROLLING AVERAGE 300 ms
RST = [C] I A RMS= 0.00 A I>>>
I>>> ?
10.0 In
Yes
Max IA RMS ROLLING AVERAGE
350 A I B RMS= 0.00 A t I>>>
110 ms I>>> sample
Yes
Page 27/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
PROTECTION
G1/G2
Page 28/32
P12x/EN HI/F65
[50N/51N] E/Gnd [46] Neg Seq OC [49] Therm OL [37] Undercurrent [79] Autoreclose
t Ie >>
300 ms
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Trip Commands Latch Functions Blocking Logic 1/2 Logic Select 1/2 Output Relays
1000100
No Yes I>
Trip tI >> Latch tI >> Block 1 tI >> Sel 1 tI >>> tl >
Yes Trip tAux 1 Yes Latch tAux 1 Yes Yes I >>
Yes Yes tl >>
Trip tI >>> Latch tI >>> Block 1 tI >>> Sel1 tle >> I >>>
Trip tAux 2 tl >>>
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Page 29/32
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
AUTOMAT. CTRL
Page 30/32
Latch Output
Inputs 1/2/3/4/5 Broken Conductor Cold Load PU CB Fail CB Supervision
P12x/EN HI/F65
Relays
Cold Load PU n
Aux4 Time 2
Level 120 %
tAux4 50 ms
Cold Load PU
tCL 2s
MiCOM P123 - V6 Software - Menu content
Menu Content Tables
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DEFAULT DISPLAY
IA = 1245 A
RECORDS
CB Monitoring Fault Record Instantaneous Disturb Record Time Peak Value Rolling Demand
Menu Content Tables
CB Opening Time Record Number Number Pre-Time Time Window Sub Period
83 ms 4 5 1.3 s 5 mn 1mn
IA Magnitude
1200 A
IB Magnitude
MiCOM P123 - V6 Software
500 A
IC Magnitude
Menu content
480 A
IN Magnitude
103 A
P12x/EN HI/F65
Page 31/32
P12x/EN HI/F65 Menu Content Tables
BLANK PAGE
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CONTENTS
1. PROTECTION FUNCTIONS 3
1.1 Phase Overcurrent Protection (P121, P122 & P123 Only) 3
1.2 Neutral/Ground/Earth Overcurrent Protection 4
1.3 Sensitive ground/Earth overcurrent protection 5
1.4 Thermal overload protection (P122 & P123 only) 6
1.5 Undercurrent protection (P122 & P123 only) 6
1.6 Negative sequence overcurrent protection (P122 & P123 only) 6
2. AUTOMATION FUNCTIONS 7
2.1 Cold load pickup (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.2 Auxiliary timers (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.3 Multishot autorecloser (P123 only) 7
2.4 Broken conductor detection (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.5 Circuit breaker failure (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.6 Trip circuit supervision (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.7 Circuit breaker control and monitoring (P122 & P123 only) 7
2.8 Logic selectivity (P122 & P123 only) 7
4. COMMUNICATION 9
6. ACCURACY 12
7. CT DATA 13
9. ELECTRICAL ENVIRONMENT 15
10. ENVIRONMENT 16
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
11. CURVES 17
11.1 IDMT Curves 17
11.1.1 Mathematical formula 17
11.1.2 IEC Curves 20
11.1.3 RI Curves 26
11.1.4 IEEE/ANSI & CO Curves 27
11.1.5 Rectifier protection curve 33
11.1.6 LABORELEC CURVE 34
11.2 Thermal overload curves 35
11.2.1 Mathematical formula 35
11.2.2 Tripping curve 36
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
1. PROTECTION FUNCTIONS
1.1 Phase Overcurrent Protection (P121, P122 & P123 Only)
− Hysteresis 95%
− Instantaneous time < 30 ms
− Drop out time 30 ms
− Phase time delays (tI>, tI>>, tI>>>)
DMT 0 ms to 150 s, step of 10 ms
Reset time (for DMT) 0 ms to 600 s, step of 10 ms
IDMT curves :
IEC : Short time inverse (AREVA),
Standard Inverse (IEC), Very inverse (IEC),
Extremely inverse (IEC),
Long time inverse (AREVA).
RI : (Electromechanical type).
IEEE/ANSI : Short time inverse (CO2),
Moderately inverse (ANSI),
Inverse (CO8),
Very inverse (ANSI), Extremely inverse (ANSI).
RECTIFIER : Rectifier protection application (P122 & P123 only)
Time Multiplier Setting (TMS) 0.025 to 1.5, step of 0.025
− Hysteresis 95%
− Instantaneous time < 30 ms
− Drop out time 30 ms
− Earth time delays (tIe>, tIe>>, tIe>>>)
DMT 0 ms to 150 s, step of 10 ms
Reset time (for DMT) 0 ms to 600 s, step of 10 ms
IDMT Curves IEC : Short time inverse (AREVA),
Standard Inverse (IEC),
Very inverse (IEC),
Extremely inverse (IEC),
Long time inverse (AREVA).
RI : (Electromechanical type).
IEEE/ANSI : Short time inverse (CO2),
Moderately inverse (ANSI),
Inverse (CO8),
Very inverse (ANSI),
Extremely inverse (ANSI).
RECTIFIER : Rectifier protection application (P122 & P123 only)
Time Multiplier Setting (TMS) 0.025 to 1.5, step of 0.025
LABORELEC Laborelec curves 1, 2 and 3 (P122 & P123
Curves only) used with 0.01 to 8 Ien range only
− Sensitive Earth current Range 0.002 to 1 x rated current, step of 0.001 Ien
− Hysteresis 95%
− Hysteresis 95%
− I2> Time delay
DMT 0 ms to 150 s, step of 10 ms
IDMT curves IEC : Short time inverse (AREVA),
Standard Inverse (IEC),
Very inverse (IEC),
Extremely inverse (IEC),
Long time inverse (AREVA).
RI : (Electromechanical type).
IEEE/ANSI: Short time inverse (CO2),
Moderately inverse (ANSI),
Inverse (CO8),
Very inverse (ANSI),
Extremely inverse (ANSI).
Time Multiplier Setting (TMS) 0.025 to 1.5, step of 0.025
− Reset time
− If IEEE/ANSI I2> Time delay : Short time inverse (CO2),
Moderately inverse (ANSI),
Inverse (CO8),
Very inverse (ANSI),
Extremely inverse (ANSI).
or DMT: 0.04s to 100s ; step of 0.01 s
2. AUTOMATION FUNCTIONS
2.1 Cold load pickup (P122 & P123 only)
Range 20 to 500 % x nominal settings, step of 1%
Time delay tCL 0.1 s to 3600 s, step of 100 ms
2.2 Auxiliary timers (P122 & P123 only)
Auxiliary timer numbers P123: 4 independent associated to the logic
Inputs Aux 1, Aux 2, Aux 3 and Aux 4
P122: 3 independent associated to the logic
Inputs Aux 1, Aux 2 and Aux 3
tAux1, tAux2, tAux3 & tAux4 Range 0 ms to 200 s ; step of 10 ms
2.3 Multishot autorecloser (P123 only)
Main shots 4 independent shots phase and/or earth
Dead times Cycles 1 & 2 0.01 to 300 s; step of 10 ms
Cycles 3 & 4 0.01 to 600 s; step of 10 ms
Reclaim time 20 ms to 600 s; step of 10 ms
Inhibition time 20 ms to 600 s; step of 10 ms
External logic inputs 4 inputs (External CB fail, phase start,
earth start, blocking order)
2.4 Broken conductor detection (P122 & P123 only)
Principle used I2/I1
Broken conductor threshold 20 to 100 %; step of 1 %
Broken conductor time delay tBC 1 to 14400 s; step of 1 s
2.5 Circuit breaker failure (P122 & P123 only)
Under current threshold I< 2% to 100% x rated current, step of 1%
Threshold accuracy from 0.02 In to 0.1 In : 0.006 In
from 0.1 In to 1 In : 2% Is
Threshold hysteresis max. 0.008 In or 0.95 Is
CB failure time tBF 30 ms to 10 s; step of 10 ms
2.6 Trip circuit supervision (P122 & P123 only)
Trip circuit supervision time t SUP 0.1s to 10 s step 50 ms
2.7 Circuit breaker control and monitoring (P122 & P123 only)
− Circuit breaker opening time (t Open Pulse) 50 ms to 1 s; step of 10 ms
− Circuit breaker closing time (t Close Pulse) 50 ms to 1 s; step of 10 ms
− Circuit breaker opening alarm threshold 0 to 50000 operations
− Amps or square amps alarm threshold 0 to 4 109; step of 106
− Circuit breaker tripping time alarm threshold 100 ms to 5 s; step of 100 ms
− Circuit breaker closing time alarm threshold 100 ms to 5 s; step of 100 ms
2.8 Logic selectivity (P122 & P123 only)
Timer Number 2 Independent : t Sel 1 & t Sel 2
Range 0ms to 150s ; step of 10ms
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
4. COMMUNICATION
RS 485 port rear port, screened twisted wire pair
Connectors screws or snap-on
Protocols MODBUSTM RTU
Courier
IEC 60870-5-103
DNP3
Data rate 300 to 38 400 baud (programmable)
RS 232 port (P122 & P123 only) front port, screened twisted wire cable
Protocol MODBUSTM RTU
Connector Sub-D 9 pin female connector
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
Logic Output
Logic output type dry contact Ag Cdo
Logic output rating Make 30 Amps and carry for 3 s
Carry 5 Amps continuous
Break 135 Vdc, 0.3 Amps (L/R = 30 ms)
250 Vdc, 50 W resistive or 25W inductive
(L/R=40ms)
220 Vac, 5 Amps (cos ϕ = 0.6)
Logic output operation time < 7 ms
Logic output mechanical durability > 100 000 operations
5.3 Power supply
Auxiliary voltage Vaux, 4 ranges : 24–60 Vdc
48–150 Vdc
130–250 Vdc / 100-250 Vac, 50/60 Hz
125–250 Vdc / 100-250 Vac, 50/60 Hz
(special application)
Power supply variations dc ± 20 %
ac –20%, +10%
Ripple 12 %.
Power off withstand 50 ms
Burden 3 W standby + 0.25 W per energised relay
6 VA standby + 0.4 VA per energised relay.
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
6. ACCURACY
O/C Protection thresholds ±2%
Thermal replica thresholds ±5%
Time delay (DT) ± 2 % with a minimum of 10 ms
Time delay (inverse curves) conform to BS142 class 5 see time delay accuracy
table in chapter P12x/EN CM
Measurements < ± 1 % @ In
Measurements pass band 500 Hz
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
7. CT DATA
Phase CT primary 1 to 9999, step of 1
Earth CT primary 1 to 9999, step of 1
Phase CT secondary 1 or 5
Earth CT secondary 1 or 5
Phase inputs 5P10, 5 VA (typical)
Earth current Residual connection or
Core balanced CT(preferred in isolated and
compensated neutral systems)
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
9. ELECTRICAL ENVIRONMENT
High frequency IEC 61000-4-12 2.5 kV common mode, class 3
disturbance 1 kV differential mode, class 3
Fast transient IEC 61000-4-4 4 kV auxiliary voltage, class 4
ANSI C37.90.1 2 kV others, class4
Electrostatic IEC 61000-4-2 8 kV, class 4
discharge
Radio frequency ANSI C37.90.2 35 V/m
impulse IEC 61000-4-3 10 V/m
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
10. ENVIRONMENT
Temperature IEC 60-255-6 Storage -25°C to +70°C
Operation -25°C to + 55 °C
Humidity IEC 600-68-2-3 56 days at 93% RH and 40°C
Enclosure protection IEC 60-529 IP 52, IK 07
Vibrations IEC 60-255-21-1 Response and endurance, class 2
Shocks and bumps IEC 60-255-21-11 Response and withstand, class 1
Seismic IEC 60-255-21-3 Class 1
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
11. CURVES
11.1 IDMT Curves
11.1.1 Mathematical formula
11.1.1.1 IDMT threshold
Inverse Time Curves :
The first and second phases (earth) overcurrent threshold can be selected with a dependent
time characteristic. The time delay is calculated with a mathematical formula.
In all, there are eleven inverse time characteristics available.
The mathematical formula applicable to the first ten curves is :
K
t = T× + L
(I I )α − 1
S
Where:
t = Tripping time
K = Coefficient (see table)
I = Value of measured current
IS = Value of the programmed threshold (Pick-up value)
α = Coefficient (see table)
L = ANSI/IEEE coefficient (zero for IEC curves)
T = Time multiplier between 0.025 and 1.5
1
t = K ×
0.339 − 0.236 /(I / Is)
LABORELEC CURVES :
The first and second earth threshold can be selected with dedicated Laborelec curves.
There are 3 curves available with the following formula :
t = aI + b
where : t = tripping time
a and b = coefficient (see table)
I = Primary residual current (between 1 and 40A)
Type of curve a b
LABORELEC 1 – 0.0897 4.0897
LABORELEC 2 – 0.0897 4.5897
LABORELEC 3 – 0.0897 5.0897
In order to be compliant with the Laborelec specifications the relay must be used with :
DMT 0 ms 0 ms
LABORELEC *, Rectifier,
50 ms Settable from 40 ms to 100s
IDMT IEC or RI
Settable from 40 ms to 100s
or
IDMT IEEE or CO 50 ms
Inverse Time
(Choice of 5 IEEE curves)
Another possible situation where the timer hold facility may be used to reduce fault clearance
times is where intermittent faults occur. An example of this may occur in a plastic insulated
cable . In this application it is possible that the fault energy melts and reseals the cable
insulation, thereby extinguishing the fault. This process repeats to give a succession of fault
current pulses, each of increasing duration with reducing intervals between the pulses, until
the fault becomes permanent.
When the reset time of the overcurrent relay is minimum the relay will be repeatedly reset
and not be able to trip until the fault becomes permanent. By using the Timer Hold facility the
relay will integrate the fault current pulses, thereby reducing fault clearance time.
The reset timer "t Reset" facility for the MiCOM P122 & P123 can be found in the following
menu :
− If the first phase (earth) threshold is selected with an IDMT IEC or RI curve, the reset
timer "t Reset" with DMT characteristic is settable in the menu :
− If the first phase (earth) threshold is selected with an IDMT IEEE or CO curve, the
reset timer "t Reset" with a DMTor IDMT characteristic is settable in the menu :
K
t = T ×
1 − (I I s )α
Where :
t = Reset time
K = Coefficient (see table)
I = Value of the measured current
IS = Value of the programmed threshold (pick-up value)
1
TIME IN SECONDS
0,1
0,01
0,001
1 10 100
A
B
C
TIME IN SECONDS
0,1
D
0,01 E
0,001
1 10 100
P0007ENb
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
100
10
A
B
TIME IN SECONDS
C
1
0,1
0,01
1 10 100
P0008ENa
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
10
TIME IN SECONDS
1 A
B
0,01
0,001
1 10 100
P0009ENa
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
10000
1000
100
TIME IN SECONDS
10
A
B
0,1 C
0,01
0,001
1 10 100
P00010ENa
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
10000
1000
100
TIME IN SECONDS
A
B
D
1
E
0,1
1 10 100
P0011ENb
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
11.1.3 RI Curves
RI CURVES
100
10
TIME IN SECONDS
0,1
1 10 100
P0012ENa
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
10
1
TIME IN SECONDS
0,1
0,01
0,001
0,0001
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
10
1
TIME IN SECONDS
0,1
A
A B
B C
C
D
0,01
D
E
0,001 E
0,0001
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
B : TMS/RTMS=1 A : TMS/RTMS=1.25
1000
100
10
TIME IN SECONDS
A
1
A B
B C
C
D
D
0,1
E
E
0,01
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
100
10
A
B
C
D
1
TIME IN SECONDS
A
E B
0,1 C
0,01
0,001
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
1000
100
B
C
TIME IN SECONDS
10
1
A
E B
0,1
D
E
0,01
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
1000
100
A
B
10 C
D
TIME IN SECONDS
A
B
0,1 C
0,01
0,001
0,01 0,1 1 10 100
10000
1000
100
TIME IN SECONDS
45900
t=
(I/Is)5.6-1
1
0,1
1 1.6 10 100
TMS = 1
P0019ENa
P12x/EN TD/F65 Technical Data and Curve Characteristics
50
P0020ENa
1.5
1.0
0.5
40
Primary zero sequence current (A)
30
20
3
10
5
1
5
Time (sec)
Technical Data and Curve Characteristics P12x/EN TD/F65
K ² − θ²
Ttrip = Te In
K ² − θtrip²
With :
Ttrip = Time to trip (in seconds)
Te = Thermal time constant of the protected element (in seconds)
Iθ> = Full load current rating given by the national standard or by the supplier.
k = Factor associated to the thermal state formula.
θ2 = Initial thermal state. If the initial thermal state = 30% then θ2 = 0.3
θtrip2 = Trip thermal state. If the trip thermal state is set at 100%, then θ trip2 = 1
The calculation of the thermal state is given by the following formula :
1000
100
TIME IN SECONDS
A
10
B
C
D
E
1
0,1
1 10
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Application Guide
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION 5
7. RECTIFIER PROTECTION 22
29. ROLLING AND PEAK VALUE DEMANDS (P122 & P123 ONLY) 70
29.1 Rolling demand 70
29.2 Peak value demand 71
30. CT REQUIREMENTS 72
30.1 Definite time / IDMT overcurrent & earth fault protection 72
30.2 Instantaneous overcurrent & earth fault protection 72
30.3 Definite time / IDMT sensitive earth fault (SEF) protection 72
30.4 Low impedance restricted earth fault (REF) protection 73
30.5 High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault Protection 73
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
BLANK PAGE
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
1. INTRODUCTION
MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays have been designed to provide more
functionality in terms of protection, measuring, automatic operation and order control in any
medium voltage electric network.
These relays can be used in industrial and distribution network applications, as well as in
high voltage and extremely high voltage protection applications. The specific nature of these
relays makes it possible to respond to the various cases of application: energy intake,
medium voltage subscriber, cable outlet, overhead line. The earth and phase protection
functions comprise instantaneous information and time delay information. The first can be
used in logic blocking diagrams so as to optimise the performance of the protection
schemes, thus reducing triggering times. The second can be either of the constant type or of
the dependent type (IEC, ALSTOM, ANSI/IEEE, C0 and Rectifier). This wide choice of
characteristics of triggering times makes it possible to easily adapt these relays to an
existing protection scheme, irrespective of the other relays already installed on the network.
The main functions integrated in the various models are listed below:
Inst. I>
Block. tI>
&
Inst. I>>
Block. tI>>
&
Inst. I>>>
Block. tI>>>
&
Blocking logic
P0022ENa
Where:
t = Tripping time
K = Coefficient (see table)
I = Value of measured current
IS = Value of the programmed threshold (Pick-up value)
1
t = K ×
0. 339 − 0 .236 /( I / Is)
Type of curve a b
LABORELEC 1 – 0.0897 4.0897
LABORELEC 2 – 0.0897 4.5897
LABORELEC 3 – 0.0897 5.0897
In order to be compliant with the Laborelec specifications the relay must be used with :
The reset timer "t Reset" facility for the MiCOM P122 & P123 can be found in the following
menu :
− If the first phase (earth) threshold is selected with an IDMT IEC or RI curve, the reset
timer "t Reset" with DMT characteristic is settable in the menu :
− If the first phase (earth) threshold is selected with an IDMT IEEE or CO curve, the
reset timer "t Reset" with a DMTor IDMT characteristic is settable in the menu :
K
t = T ×
1 − (I I s )α
Where :
t = Reset time
K = Coefficient (see table)
I = Value of the measured current
IS = Value of the programmed threshold (pick-up value)
Incomer
I>/t> Block short time overcurrent
I>>/t>>
I>>>/t>>>
Trip
Back trip
Busbar
P0023ENa
P0024ENa
• P122 and P123 : You can use all the stages for REF application and the result of the
third stage is outstanding due to the fact of using the instantaneous value (sample
base).
• P120 and P121 : You can use all the stages for REF application. The third stage
results are identical to the first and second stage results (since all the stages are
based on Fast Fourier Transformation).
NOTE: For P122 and P123, the maximum internal fault level for the third
stage (of the 0.002 to 1In range) must not exceed 20In.
6.1 Introduction
The restricted earth fault relay is a high impedance differential scheme which balances zero
sequence current flowing in the transformer neutral against zero sequence current flowing in
the transformer phase windings. Any unbalance for
in-zone fault will result in an increasing voltage on the CT secondary and thus operating the
REF relay.
This scheme in very sensitive and can protect against the low levels of fault current inherent
in the resistance grounded system, where this fault current value is limited by the earthing
impedance and the fault point voltage governed by the fault location.
In addition, it can be used in a solidly grounded system, providing more sensitive protection,
even though the overall differential scheme provides a protection for faults over most of the
windings.
The High impedance differential Technique ensures that the relay circuit is of sufficiently high
impedance such that the differential voltage that may occur under external fault conditions is
less than that required to drive setting current through the relay. This ensures the required
stability under through fault conditions and relay operation only for faults occurring inside the
protected zone.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
Healthy CT Saturated CT
Protected
circuit
Zm Zm A-G
RCT1 RCT2
IF
R L1 R L3
VS R ST
R L2 R R L4
C
STAB
E/F Input
P0343ENa
In order to achieve the required primary operation current with a given CT, the relay setting
current must be selected for a high impedance element.
Is < {(Iop / CTRatio) - n.Ie}
Vs k If (RCT+2RL)
Is = IS
For MiCOM P12x, the Is is equivalent to Ie> , so the above equation becomes
Vs k If (RCT+2RL)
Ie> = Ie>
with
K= 1 for Vk/Vs less or equal to 16 and
K= 1.2 for Vk/Vs > 16.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
So
k If (RCT+2RL)
RST =
Ie>
with
Vk ќ 4.Is.RST (A typical value to insure the high speed operation for an internal fault).
6.3.1 CT requirements for High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault Protection
The High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault element shall maintain stability for through faults
and operate in less than 40ms for internal faults provided the following equations are met in
determining CT requirements and the value of the associated stabilising resistor:
Rs = [k* (If) * (RCT + 2RL)] / IS
VK ≥ 4 * Is * Rs
with
K= 1 for Vk/Vs less or equal to 16 and
K= 1.2 for Vk/Vs > 16.
6.4 Use of METROSIL non linear resistors
Metrosils are used to limit the peak voltage developed by the current transformers under
internal fault conditions, to a value below the insulation level of the current transformers,
relay and interconnecting leads, which are normally able to withstand 3KV peak.
The following formulae should be used to estimate the peak transient voltage that could be
produced for an internal fault. This peak voltage will be a function of
− Prospective voltage that would be produced for an internal fault if CT saturation did
not occur (Vf)
This prospective voltage, in turns, is a function of
− CT ratio
Where
V = C.I0.25
Where
− Vs(rms) : RMS value of the sinusoidal voltage applied across the Metrosil.
This is due to the fact that the current waveform through the Metrosil is not sinusoidal but
appreciably distorted.
For satisfactory application of the non-linear resistor (Metrosil), its characteristics should be
such that it complies with the following requirements:
− At the relay voltage setting, the non-linear resistor (Metrosil) current should be as
low as possible, but no greater than approximately 30mA rms for 1A current
transformers and approximately 100mA rms for 5A current transformer.
− At the maximum secondary current, the non-linear resistor (Metrosil) should limit
the voltage to 1500V rms or 2120V peak for 0.25 second. At higher relay voltage
settings, it is not always possible to limit the fault voltage to 1500V rms, so higher
fault voltage may have to be tolerated.
The following tables show the typical Metrosil types that will be required, depending on relay
current rating, REF voltage setting etc.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
− At the relay voltage setting, the Metrosil current should be less than 30mA rms.
− At the maximum secondary internal fault current, the Metrosil unit should limit the
voltage to 1500V rms if possible.
The Metrosil units normally recommended for use with 1Amp CTs are shown in the following
table:
NOTE: Single pole Relay Metrosil Units are normally supplied without
mounting brackets unless otherwise specified by the customer.
6.4.2 Metrosil units for relays with 5A CT
These Metrosil units have been designed to comply with the following requirements:
− At the relay voltage setting, the Metrosil current should be less than 100mA rms (the
actual maximum currents passed by the units shown below their type description)
− At the maximum secondary internal fault current the Metrosil unit should limit the
voltage to 1500V rms for 0.25 second. At the higher relay settings, it is not possible to
limit the fault voltage to 1500V rms, hence higher voltage have to be tolerated (
indicated by * ,** , *** ).
The Metrosil units normally recommended for use with 5 Amps CTs and singlee pole relays
are as shown in the following table:
Amps rms Up to 200V rms 250V rms 275V rms 300V rms
600A/S1/S1213 600A/S1/S1214 600A/S1/S1214 600A/S1/S1223
50A C= 540/640 C= 670/800 C= 670/800 C= 740/870*
35mA rms 40mA rms 50mA rms 50mA rms
600A/S2/P/S1217 600A/S2/P/S1215 600A/S2/P/S1215 600A/S2/P/S1196
100A C= 470/540 C= 570/670 C= 570/670 C= 620/740*
35mA rms 75mA rms 100mA rms 100mA rms
600A/S3/P/S1219 600A/S3/P/S1220 600A/S3/P/S1221 600A/S3/P/S1222
150A C= 430/500 C= 520/620 C= 570/670** C= 620/740***
100mA rms 100mA rms 100mA rms 100mA rms
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
7. RECTIFIER PROTECTION
The rectifiers require a specific inverse time protection curve.
The protection of a rectifier differs from that of conventional current maximum applications. In
fact, a large number of rectifiers can withstand relatively long periods of overcharge without
incurring damage, generally 150 % for 2 hours and 300 % for 1 minute.
A typical application of this characteristic is shown on the diagram below.
A +
B
C -
A B C N
Rs
Transformer Rectifier
Protection P0025ENa
10000
Protection curve
100 Instantaneous
Time (seconds)
overcurrent
10
Typical
1 load area
0.1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Multiple of rated current P0026ENa
The relay I> setting of the relay should be set to the rated rms value of the current that flows
into the transformer when the rectifier is delivering its rated load. The relay will give a start
indication when the current exceeds this setting but this is of no consequence because this
function is not used in this application. Rectifier curve should be selected for the inverse time
curve and this cuts-off for currents below 1.6 times allowing the rectifier to carry 150%
overload for long periods. If this is not acceptable the I> setting can be adjusted to move the
cut-off point relative to the current scale. The operation time can be modified by adjustment
of the time multiplier setting (TMS) so that it lies between limiting characteristic of the rectifier
and the allowable load area.
Typical settings for the TMS area :
Light industrial service TMS = 0.025
Medium duty service TMS = 0.1
Heavy duty traction TMS = 0.8
The high set is typically set at 8 times rated current as this ensures HV AC protection will
discriminate with faults covered by the LV protection. However, it has been known for the
high set to be set to 4 or 5 times where there is more confidence in the AC protection.
Use of the thermal element to provide protection between 70% and 160% of rated current
could enhance the protection. It is also common practice to provide restricted earth fault
protection for the transformer feeding the rectifier. See the appropriate section dealing with
restricted earth fault protection.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
Incomer
Feeder 1 Feeder n
P0027ENa
− 3rd threshold: tI>>> time delay at 60ms (active threshold for the high phase faults)
− 2nd threshold: tI>> time delay selectively greater than for the third threshold, i.e.
360ms.
The output contact associated with the 2nd threshold is cabled in series with the watch-dog
contact of the downstream relays, so as to act on the triggering coil of the circuit breakers of
the outputs. As for the output contact associated with the 2nd and 3rd threshold, this is
directly cabled onto the triggering coil of the incoming circuit breaker.
Busbar
Distance protection
Circuit Breaker
21
P 121
50/51
Feeder P0028ENa
Busbar
Circuit
Breaker
Circuit Breaker
CT
P121
50/51
CT
Circuit
Breaker
Busbar
Contactor
Feeder
P0029ENa
K 2 − θ2
Ttrip = Te In 2
K − θtrip²
With :
Ttrip = Time to trip (in seconds)
Te = Thermal time constant of the protected element (in seconds)
Iθ > = Full load current rating given by the national standard or by the supplier.
k = Factor associated to the thermal state formula.
θ2 = Initial thermal state. If the initial thermal state = 30% then θ2 = 0.3
θtrip2 = Trip thermal state. If the trip thermal state is set at 100%,
then θ trip2 = 1
The settings of these parameters are available in the menus :
PROTECTION G1/ [49] Therm OL
PROTECTION G2/ [49] Therm OL
The calculation of the thermal state is given by the following formula :
An alarm can be raised on reaching a thermal state corresponding to a percentage of the trip
threshold. A typical setting might be ‘Thermal Trip’ = 70% of thermal capacity.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
tCL controls the time for which the relevant overcurrent and earth fault settings (%) are
altered following an external input (e.g. circuit breaker closure). When the set tCL time has
elapsed, all of the relevant settings revert back to their original values or become unblocked.
tCL are initiated via a dedicated logic input (refer to AUTOMAT. CTRL/INPUTS menu) signal
generated by connecting an auxiliary contact from the circuit breaker or starting device to the
relay’s opto-inputs.
The following sections describe applications where the CLP logic may be useful and the
settings that need to be applied.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
To avoid nuisance tripping, the setting group change is only executed when no protection
function (except for thermal overload function) or automation function is running.
If a setting group change is received during any protection or automation function, it is stored
and executed after the last timer has elapsed.
The active group is displayed in the OP PARAMETERS menu.
The active group can also be assigned to an output relay : with a normally open contact,
− Switch ON the power supply of the relay with the voltage applied to the logic input
=0V:
The group will not change. It will remain as before the switching off of the relay.
− Switch ON the power supply of the relay with the voltage applied to the logic input
=+V:
The group will change and it will change after every switching off.
B- FRONT option with Logic input configuration = 0
The active group changes every time the voltage applied to the logic input changes state
from +V to 0V.
Switch OFF the relay, then if we
− Switch ON the power supply of the relay with the voltage applied to the logic input
=0V:
The group will change state and it will change after every switching off.
− Switch ON the power supply of the relay with the voltage applied to the logic input
=+V:
The group will not change. It will remain as before the switching off of the relay.
NOTE : It is important to set properly the change active group with FRONT
option via a logic input. In general the customer should be conform to
the cases A-1 and B-2, so no group changes will take place upon
energizing the relay.
Priority
The front panel is priority level maximum due the fact when the user takes the hand on front
panel and enters a password , it is not possible to change of setting group via remote
communication as long as the password is active (5mn).
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
Maintenance Mode
YES
When activating this menu (YES), the Alarm led will start flashing and an alarm message will
appear “MAINTENANCE MODE”. In this case, all output contacts are blocked, no operation
will take place on these contacts even if a protection threshold associated to one of these
output contacts is exceeded.
(If protection threshold is exceeded, all the associated leds will become ON, even the TRIP
LED, if the threshold is associated to the RL1).
RELAYS 8765W4321
CMD 000000000
This window allows the user to verify the external wiring to the relay output contacts, to do
this, it is sufficient to assign a 1 to any of the output contacts, this will close the contact and
the wiring continuity could be verified.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
P0024ENa
• In certain applications, residual current may not be detected by an earth fault relay
due to the system configuration. For example, an earth fault relay applied on the delta
side of a delta-star transformer is unable to detect earth faults on the star side.
However, negative sequence current will be present on both sides of the transformer
for any fault condition, irrespective of the transformer configuration. Therefore, an
negative phase sequence overcurrent element may be employed to provide time-
delayed back-up protection for any uncleared asymmetrical faults.
• Where rotating machines are protected by fuses, a blown fuse produces a large
amount of negative sequence current. This is a dangerous condition for the machine
due to the heating effects of negative phase sequence current at double frequency. A
negative phase sequence overcurrent element may be applied to provide efficient
back-up protection for dedicated motor protection relays.
• It may also be required to simply alarm for the presence of negative phase sequence
currents on the system. Operators are then prompted to investigate the cause of the
unbalance.
The negative phase sequence overcurrent element has a current pick up setting ‘I2> Current
Set’, and is time delayed in operation by the adjustable timer ‘I2> Time Delay.’
17.1 I2> and I2>> Setting Guidelines
The current pick-up threshold (settable in the PROTECTION G1 (2)/[46] Neg Seg 0C menu)
must be set higher than the normal negative phase sequence current due to the normal load
unbalance on the system. This can be set at the commissioning stage, making use of the
relay measurement function to display the standing negative phase sequence current, and
apply a setting at least 20% above this figure.
Where the negative phase sequence element is required to operate for specific uncleared
asymmetric faults, a precise threshold setting have to be based on an individual fault
analysis for that particular system due to the complexities involved. However, to ensure
operation of the protection, the current pick-up setting must be set approximately 20% below
the lowest calculated negative phase sequence fault current for a specific remote fault
condition.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
The correct setting of the time delay for this function is vital. It should also be noted that this
element is applied primarily to provide back-up protection to other protective devices or to
provide an alarm. Therefore, it would be associated with a long time delay.
It must be ensured that the time delay is set greater than the operating time of any other
protective device (at minimum fault level) on the system which may respond to unbalanced
faults, such as:
Setting Guidelines
In the case of a single point earthed power system, there will be little zero sequence current
flow and the ratio of I2/I1 that flows in the protected circuit will approach 100%. In the case of
a multiple earthed power system (assuming equal impedances in each sequence network),
the ratio I2/I1 will be 50%.
It is possible to calculate the ratio of I2/I1 that will occur for varying system impedances, by
referring to the following equations:-
Eg(Z2+Z0)
I1F =
Z1Z2+Z1Z0+Z2Z0
–EgZ0
I2F =
Z1Z2+Z1Z0+Z2Z0
Where :
Eg = System Voltage
Z0 = Zero sequence impedance
Z1 = Positive sequence impedance
Z2 = Negative sequence impedance
Therefore :
I2F Z0
=
I1F Z0+Z2
It follows that, for an open circuit in a particular part of the system, I2/I1 can be determined
from the ratio of zero sequence to negative sequence impedance. It must be noted however,
that this ratio may vary depending upon the fault location. It is desirable therefore to apply as
sensitive a setting as possible. In practice, this minimum setting is governed by the levels of
standing negative phase sequence current present on the system. This can be determined
from a system study, or by making use of the relay measurement facilities at the
commissioning stage. If the latter method is adopted, it is important to take the
measurements during maximum system load conditions, to ensure that all single phase
loads are accounted for.
Since sensitive settings are employed, it can be expected that the element will operate for
any unbalance condition occurring on the system (for example, during a single pole
autoreclose cycle). Therefore, a long time delay is necessary to ensure co-ordination with
other protective devices. A 60 second time delay setting may be typical.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
The following table shows the relay menu for the Broken Conductor protection, including the
available setting ranges and factory defaults :
Set tBC = 60 s to allow adequate time for short circuit fault clearance by time delayed
protections.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
• Reduces operating costs - less man hours in repairing fault damage and the
possibility of running substations unattended. With autoreclose instantaneous
protection can be used which means shorter fault duration’s which gives rise to less
fault damage and fewer permanent faults.
As 80% of overhead line faults are transient, elimination of loss of supply from such faults, by
the introduction of autoreclosing gives obvious benefits. Furthermore, autoreclosing may
allow a particular substation to operate unattended. In the case of unattended substations,
the number of visits by personnel to reclose a circuit breaker manually after a fault can be
substantially reduced, an important consideration for substations in remote areas.
Autoreclosing gives an important benefit on circuits using time graded protection, in that it
allows the use of instantaneous protection to give a high speed first trip. With fast tripping,
the duration of the power arc resulting from an overhead line fault is reduced to a minimum,
thus lessening the chance of damage to the line, which might otherwise cause a transient
fault to develop into a permanent fault.
Using short time delay protection also prevents blowing of fuses and reduces circuit breaker
maintenance by eliminating pre-arc heating when clearing transient faults.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
O C O C O C O C O final trip
I threshold
Time
Fault P0031ENa
• The auxiliary contact of the CB status 52a must be connected to the relay
See AUTOMAT. CTRL/Inputs menu
• The trip output relay RL1 must not be latched to the earth and/or phase protection
function
See AUTOMAT. CTRL/Latch functions menu
NOTE : If the auxiliary supply is lost during an autoreclose cycle, the
autoreclose function is totally disabled.
19.2.2 Autoreclose menu
The following table shows the relay settings for the autoreclose function, including the
available setting ranges. The same settings are available in the PROTECTION 2 Menu.
Example of setting :
CYCLES 4321
tI> 1201
4321 are the cycles 1 to 4 associated to the trip on tI> pick up
1201 are the actions following the tI> time out :
0= no action on autorecloser : definitive trip
1= trip on tI> pick up, followed by reclosing cycle
2= no trip on tI> pick up : and this whatever the setting in AUTOMAT.
CRTL/Trip commands/Trip tI> menu.
The "Final trip" signal is allocated to the output relays in the AUTOMAT.Ctrl/Output
Relays/79 Trip menu.
Autoreclose lockout can also be caused by a CB FLT input. This CB FLT information can be
issued from the CB springs are not charged/Low gas pressure.
Note, lockout can also be caused by :
19.3.2.1 Load
Due to the great diversity of load which may exist on a system it may prove very difficult to
arrive at an optimum dead time. However, it is possible to address each type of load
individually and thereby arrive at a typical dead time. The most common types of load are
addressed below.
Synchronous motors are only capable of tolerating extremely short interruptions of supply
without loss of synchronism. In practice it is desirable to disconnect the motor from the
supply in the event of a fault; the dead time should be sufficient to allow the motor no-volt
device to operate. Typically, a minimum dead time of 0.2-0.3 seconds has been suggested
to allow this device to operate. Induction motors, on the other hand, can withstand supply
interruptions, up to a maximum of 0.5 seconds and re-accelerate successfully. In general
dead times of 3-10 seconds are normally satisfactory, but there may be special cases for
which additional time is required to permit the resetting of manual controls and safety
devices.
Loss of supply to lighting circuits, such as street lighting may be important for safety reasons
as intervals of 10 seconds or more may be dangerous for traffic. The main considerations for
domestic customers are those of inconvenience.
An important measurement criteria for many power utilities is the number of minutes lost per
year to customers which will be reduced on feeders using autoreclose and will also be
affected by the dead time settings used.
19.3.2.2 Circuit Breaker
For high speed autoreclose the minimum dead time of the power system will depend on the
minimum time delays imposed by the circuit breaker during a tripping and reclosing
operation.
Since a circuit breaker is a mechanical device, it will have an inherent contact separation
time. This operating time for a modern circuit breaker is usually within the range of 50-
100ms, but could be longer with older designs.
After tripping, time must be allowed for the mechanism to reset before applying a closing
pulse. This resetting time will vary depending on the circuit breaker, but is typically 0.1
seconds.
Once the circuit breaker has reset, the breaker can begin to close. The time interval between
the energisation of the closing mechanism and the making of the contacts is termed the
closing time. Owing to the time constant of a solenoid closing mechanism and the inertia of
the plunger, a solenoid closing mechanism may take 0.3s. A spring operated breaker, on the
other hand, can close in less than 0.2 seconds.
Where high speed reclosing is required, for the majority of medium voltage applications, the
circuit breaker mechanism itself dictates the minimum dead time. However, the fault de-
ionising time may also have to be considered.
High speed autoreclose may be required to maintain stability on a network with two or more
power sources. For high speed autoreclose the system disturbance time should be
minimised by using fast protection, <50 ms, such as distance or feeder differential protection
and fast circuit breakers < 100 ms. Fast fault clearance can reduce the required fault arc de-
ionising time.
For stability between two sources a dead time of <300 ms may typically be required. The
minimum system dead time only considering the CB is the mechanism reset time plus the
CB closing time. Thus, a solenoid mechanism will not be suitable for high speed autoreclose
as the closing time is generally too long.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
• Supply continuity - Large reclaim times can result in unnecessary lockout for transient
faults.
• Fault incidence/Past experience - Small reclaim times may be required where there is
a high incidence of lightning strikes to prevent unnecessary lockout for transient faults.
• Spring charging time - For high speed autoreclose the reclaim time may be set longer
than the spring charging time to ensure there is sufficient energy in the circuit breaker
to perform a trip-close-trip cycle. For delayed autoreclose there is no need as the dead
time can be extended by an extra CB healthy check window time if there is insufficient
energy in the CB. If there is insufficient energy after the check window time the relay
will lockout.
• Switchgear Maintenance - Excessive operation resulting from short reclaim times can
mean shorter maintenance periods. A minimum reclaim time of >5s may be needed to
allow the CB time to recover after a trip and close before it can perform another trip-
close-trip cycle. This time will depend on the duty (rating) of the CB.
The reclaim time must be long enough to allow any time delayed protection initiating
autoreclose to operate. Failure to do so would result in premature resetting of the
autoreclose scheme and re-enabling of instantaneous protection.
If this condition arose, a permanent fault would effectively look like a number of transient
faults, resulting in continuous autoreclosing unless additional measures were taken to
overcome this such as excessive fault frequency lockout protection.
It is possible to have short reclaim times by blocking the reclaim time from the protection
start signals. If short reclaim times are to be used then the switchgear rating may dictate the
minimum reclaim time. The advantage of a short reclaim time is that there are less lockouts
of the CB, however, there will be more CB operations and so maintenance periods would be
reduced.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
Sensitive earth fault protection is applied to detect high resistance earth faults and usually
has a long time delay, typically 10-15s. This longer time may have to be taken into
consideration, if autoreclosing from SEF protection, when deciding on a reclaim time, if the
reclaim time is not blocked by an SEF protection start signal. Sensitive earth faults, for
example, a broken overhead conductor in contact with dry ground or a wood fence, is rarely
transient and may be a danger to the public.
It is therefore common practice to block autoreclose by operation of sensitive earth fault
protection and lockout the circuit breaker.
Where motor-wound spring closed circuit breakers are used, the reclaim time must be at
least as long as the spring winding time for high speed autoreclose to ensure that the
breaker can perform a trip-close-trip cycle.
A typical 11/33kV reclaim time is 3-10 seconds, this prevents unnecessary lockout during
thunderstorms. However, times up to 60-180 seconds maybe used.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
MENU TEXT
CB Monitoring
CB Opening Time Display the CB opening time (Note 1)
CB Closing Time Display the CB closing time (Note 2)
CB Operations Display the number of opening commands executed by the CB
ΣAmps(n) IA Display the summation of the Amps (or square Amps)
interrupted by the CB phase A
Σ Amps(n) IB Display the summation of the Amps (or square Amps)
interrupted by the CB phase B
Σ Amps(n) IC Display the summation of the Amps (or square Amps)
interrupted by the CB phase C
NOTE 1: the CB opening time is measured between the trip command (Trip
output relay) and the change of position of O/O (52a).
NOTE 2: the CB closing time is measured between the closing command
(output auxiliary relay) and the change of position of O/O (52a).
The above counters may be reset to zero, for example, following a maintenance inspection
and overhaul.
The following table, detailing the options available for the CB condition monitoring, is taken
from the relay menu. It includes the setup of the current broken facility and those features
which can be set to raise an alarm or CB lockout.
Application Guide P12x/EN AP/F65
SETTING RANGE
MENU TEXT STEP SIZE
MIN MAX
CB Supervision
CB Open S’vision No Yes
CB Open Time 50 ms 1 000 ms 50 ms
CB Close S’vision No Yes
CB Close Time 50 ms 1 000 ms 50 ms
CB Open Alarm ? No Yes
CB Open NB 0 50 000 1
ΣAmps (n) ? No Yes
ΣAmps (n) 0 4 000 E6 1 E6
n 1 2 1
t Open Pulse 100 ms 5 000 ms 100 ms
t Close Pulse 100 ms 5 000 ms 100 ms
The circuit breaker condition monitoring counters will be updated every time the relay issues
a trip command. In cases where the breaker is tripped by an external protection device it is
also possible to update the CB condition monitoring. This is achieved by allocating one of the
logic inputs or via the communication to accept a trigger from an external device.
21.2 Setting guidelines
The Σ In counter monitors the cumulative severity of the duty placed on the interrupter
allowing a more accurate assessment of the circuit breaker condition to be made.
For OCB’s, the dielectric withstand of the oil generally decreases as a function of Σ I2t. This
is where ‘I’ is the fault current broken, and ‘t’ is the arcing time within the interrupter tank (not
the interrupting time). As the arcing time cannot be determined accurately, the relay would
normally be set to monitor the sum of the broken current squared, by setting n = 2.
For other types of circuit breaker, especially those operating on higher voltage systems,
practical evidence suggests that the value of n = 2 may be inappropriate. In such
applications n’ may be set to 1.
An alarm in this instance may be indicative of the need for gas/vacuum interrupter HV
pressure testing, for example.
It is imperative that any maintenance programme must be fully compliant with the switchgear
manufacturer’s instructions.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
Alarm
indication
Ia under
I< threshold
Ib under tI< 0
I< threshold >=1
& Output
Ic under Relays
I< threshold Digital
Input 52a P0032ENa
− at least one of the 3 phase current is detected under the threshold I<
23. CIRCUIT BREAKER FAILURE PROTECTION : CBF (P122 & P123 ONLY)
Following inception of a fault one or more main protection devices will operate and issue a
trip output to the circuit breaker(s) associated with the faulted circuit. Operation of the circuit
breaker is essential to isolate the fault, and prevent damage / further damage to the power
system.
For transmission/sub-transmission systems, slow fault clearance can also threaten system
stability. It is therefore common practice to install circuit breaker failure protection, which
monitors that the circuit breaker has opened within a reasonable time. If the fault current has
not been interrupted following a set time delay from circuit breaker trip initiation, breaker
failure protection (CBF) will operate.
CBF operation can be used to backtrip upstream circuit breakers to ensure that the fault is
isolated correctly. CBF operation can also reset all start output contacts, ensuring that any
blocks asserted on upstream protection are removed.
CB Fail Enabled
Any Trip
tBF CB Fail Alarm
1 S
Q
External CBF R
Initiate
CBF Ia<
CBF Ib<
CBF Ic<
P0428ENa
In the window of 20 samples, the relay checks that the current signal going out the I<
bandzone is in opposite way than the first one.
• If there is no current signal going out in opposite way than the first one, the relay
states there is an opened CB pole condition. The « CB pole open » internal signal is
initiated.
• If there is a current signal going out in opposite way than the first one, the relay states
the pole of the CB is not yet open. The « CB pole closed » internal signal is
maintained.
At the drop off the t BF time delay, the relay checks what is the internal status of each pole of
the breaker device. If one or several internal signals mention one or several are not opened,
the P122/P123 relay initiates the CB FAIL signal. The “CB failure” message is displayed.
Note the possibility to start the CB fail detection function by a digital input without trip order
given by the MiCOM relay. In this case the tBF timer starts on the digital input. If the CB is
not open (by an another protection relay) at the end of tBF, the MiCOM relay initiates the CB
FAIL signal.
The configuration of the digital input to the "CB Fail detection" function is done in the
AUTOMAT. CTRL/Inputs menu.
The Figure 15 below shows a CB Fail detection start further to the trip order :
Trip order
t BF timer
20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples
I< threshold
I< threshold
The Figure 16 below shows a normal CB operation before tBF expired. No CB fail signal is
given.
CB pole opened
detection
« CB pole closed » internal signal
Trip order
t BF timer
20 samples 20 samples 20 samples
I< threshold
I< threshold
P0034ENa
20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples
CB failed
« CB FAIL » signal
Trip order
t BF timer
20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples
I< threshold
I< threshold
« CB pole opened »
detection
« CB pole closed» internal signal
Trip order
t BF timer
20 samples 20 samples 20 samples 20 samples
I< threshold
I< threshold
SETTING RANGE
MENU TEXT STEP SIZE
MIN MAX
CB Fail ? No Yes
tBF 0.03 s 10 s 10 ms
I< 0.02 In In 0.01 In
SETTING RANGE
MENU TEXT STEP SIZE
MIN MAX
TC Supervision ? Yes No
tSUP 100ms 10s 50ms
+Vdc
52a
2 6 Trip
order Opto-
input
MiCOM P123
- Vdc
P0038ENa
+Vdc
2 6
Trip
order Opto-
input
MiCOM P123
52a 52b
- Vdc
P0039ENa
Example 3
In this example both 52a and 52b auxiliary contacts are available, the MiCOM relay monitors
the whole of the trip circuit whatever the CB status (CB open or CB closed).
In this case a resistor R1 is necessary to avoid a full current in the trip coil with CB already
open (52a open), if either the contact trip order is latched, or it stays involuntary closed, or a
long time trip pulse is programmed.
+Vdc
2 6
Trip
order Opto-
input
MiCOM P123
52a 52b
Resistor R1
Trip Coil
- Vdc
P0040ENa
FIGURE 22 : TRIP COIL AND AUXILIARY CONTACTS MONITORING WHATEVER THE POSITION OF
THE CB
EXTERNAL RESISTOR R1 CALCULATION
The calculation of the R1 resistor value will take in account a minimum current value flowing
through the opto-input. This minimum current value is function of the relay auxiliary voltage
range.
1 - Case of example No 2 :
The R1 resistor maximum value (in Ohm) is defined by the following formula :
R1 < (0,8 * Vdc – Vmini) / Imini
Where :
Vdc = auxiliary voltage value ( dc voltage)
Vmini = internal minimum voltage value needful for the opto-input operation
Imini = minimum current value needful for the opto-input operation
2 - Case of example No 3 :
The R1 resistor maximum value (in Ohm) is defined by the following formula :
R1 < (0,8 * Vdc – Vmini) / Imini - Rcoil
Where :
Vdc = auxiliary voltage value ( dc voltage).
Vmini = internal minimum voltage value needful for the opto-input operation
Imini = minimum current value needful for the opto-input operation
Rcoil = Trip coil resistance value
SETTING RANGE
MENU TEXT STEP SIZE
MIN MAX
Disturb Record
Pre-Time 100 ms 3000 ms 100 ms
Post-Time 100 ms 3000 ms 100 ms
Disturb Rec Trig On Instantaneous On Trip
The total recording time is set by a combination of the pre and post fault recording times. For
example, the default settings show that the pre-time time is set to 100 ms and if the post -
time is set to 2.5 s, than the total disturbance recording time will be 2.6 s.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
29. ROLLING AND PEAK VALUE DEMANDS (P122 & P123 ONLY)
The MiCOM P122 and P123 relays are able to store the 3 phases rolling average and
maximum subperiod values. The description and principle of calculation are given bellow.
29.1 Rolling demand
The principle of the calculation of the rolling demand value for IA, Ib and IC currents is
following :
− Calculation of the average of the RMS values on a "Rolling Sub Period" period.
The setting of the width of the period "Rolling Sub Period" is in the "RECORDS/Rolling
Demand/Sub Period" menu.
Setting range : from 1 to 60 minutes.
− Calculation of the average of these average values (sliding window values) on the
number of "Num of Sub Periods" periods.
The setting of the number of Sub Period "Num of Sub Periods" in the "RECORDS/Rolling
Demand/Num of Sub Per" menu.
Setting range : from 1 to 24.
− Display of the first result in the MEASUREMENTS menu only after the storage of
"Num of Sub Periods" periods. The 3 phases Rolling average value are displayed :
Rolling Average IA RMS
Rolling Average IB RMS
Rolling Average IC RMS
− The calculation is reset by either "hand Reset" (by key !) without use of password, or
a remote command.
NOTE : In case of loss of power supply the rolling demand are not stored.
A modification of the settings (either "Rolling Sub Period" or "Num of
Sub Periods" parameter) reset the calculation.
Example :
Sub Period = 5 mn
Num of Sub Period = 2
5 mn 5 mn 5 mn
− The calculation is reset by either "hand Reset" (by key !) without use of password, or
a remote command.
NOTE : In case of loss of power supply the Peak average values are stored.
A modification of the setting "Rolling Sub Period" parameter reset the
calculation.
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
30. CT REQUIREMENTS
The CT requirements for the MiCOM P12x Overcurrent relays are given below.
The current transformer requirements are based on a maximum prospective fault current of
50 times the relay rated current (In) and the relay having an instantaneous setting of 25
times rated current (In). The current transformer requirements are designed to provide
operation of all protection elements.
Where the criteria for a specific application are in excess of those detailed above, or the
actual lead resistance exceeds the limiting value quoted, the CT requirements may need to
be increased according to the formulae in the following sections.
VK ≥ 48 * In * (RCT + 2RL) for X/R < 40, 15In < If < 40In
and 40 <X/R < 120, If < 15In
Where :
VK = Required CT knee point voltage (volts),
In = Rated secondary current (amps),
RCT = Resistance of current transformer secondary winding (ohms)
RL = Resistance of a single lead from relay to current transformer (ohms),
If = Maximum through fault current level (amps).
30.5 High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault Protection
The High Impedance Restricted Earth Fault element shall maintain stability for through faults
and operate in less than 40ms for internal faults provided the following equations are met in
determining CT requirements and the value of the associated stabilising resistor:
Rs = [K * (If) * (RCT + 2RL)] / IS
VK ≥ 4 * Is * Rs
K = 1 for Vk/Vs less or equal to 16
K = 1.2 for Vk/Vs greater than 16
Where :
VK = Required CT knee-point voltage (volts),
Rs = Value of Stabilising resistor (ohms),
If = Maximum through fault current level (amps).
VK = CT knee point voltage (volts),
IS = Current setting of REF element (amps),
RCT = Resistance of current transformer secondary winding (ohms),
RL = Resistance of a single lead from relay to current transformer (ohms).
P12x/EN AP/F65 Application Guide
BLANK PAGE
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
MODBUS DATABASE
COURIER DATABASE
IEC 60870-5-103
DNP 3.0 DATABASE
MiCOM P120 - P121 - P122 - P123
VERSION V6.E
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
MODBUS DATABASE
MiCOM P120 - P121 - P122 - P123
VERSION V6
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 1/168
CONTENT
1. INTRODUCTION 3
1.1 Purpose of this document 3
1.2 Glossary 3
2. MODBUS PROTOCOL 4
2.1 Technical characteristics of the MODBUS connection 4
2.1.1 Parameters of the MODBUS connection 4
2.1.2 Synchronisation of exchanges messages 4
2.1.3 Message validity check 4
2.1.4 Address of the MiCOM relays 4
2.2 MODBUS functions of the MiCOM relays 5
2.3 Presentation of the MODBUS protocol 5
2.3.1 Format of frames sent by the MiCOM relays 5
2.3.2 Messages validity check 6
1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Purpose of this document
This document describes the characteristics of the MODBUS, K-Bus/COURIER and IEC
60870-5-103 communication protocol of MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays.
1.2 Glossary
Ir, Is, It : currents measured on the concerned phases (r, s, t)
IE : residual current measured by earth input (= 3.I zero sequence)
pf : soft weight of a word of 16 bits
PF : heavy weight of a word of 16 bits
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 4/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
2. MODBUS PROTOCOL
MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays can communicate by a RS 485 link behind the
unit following the MODBUS RTU protocol.
2.1 Technical characteristics of the MODBUS connection
2.1.1 Parameters of the MODBUS connection
The different parameters of the MODBUS connection are as follows:
Baud rate
300
600
1200
2400
4800
9600
19200
38400
Mode
1 start / 8 bits / 1 stop: total 10 bits
1 start / 8 bits / even parity / 1 stop: total 11 bits
1 start / 8 bits / odd parity / 1 stop: total 11 bits
1 start / 8 bits / 2 stop: total 11 bits
Slave number:
The slave number is situated between 1 and 255.
A frame transmitted with a slave number 0 is globally addressed to all pieces of equipment
(broadcast frame )
Function code:
Requested MODBUS function (1 to 16)
Information:
Contains the parameters of the selected function.
CRC16:
Value of the CRC16 calculated by the master.
NOTE: The MiCOM relay does not respond to globally broadcast frames sent
out by the master.
2.3.1 Format of frames sent by the MiCOM relays
Frame sent by the MiCOM relay ( response)
Slave number:
The slave number is situated between 1 and 255.
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 6/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Function code:
Processed MODBUS function (1 to 16) .
Data:
Contains reply data to master query .
CRC 16:
Value of the CRC 16 calculated by the slave.
2.3.2 Messages validity check
When MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays receive a master query, it validates the
frame:
If the CRC is false, the frame is invalid. MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays do not
reply to the query. The master must retransmit its query. Excepting a broadcast message,
this is the only case of non-reply by MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays to a master
query.
If the CRC is good but the MiCOM relay can not process the query, it sends an exception
response.
Warning frame sent by the MiCOM relay (response)
Slave number:
The slave number is situated between 1 and 255.
Function code:
The function code returned by the MiCOM relay in the warning frame is the code in which the
most significant bit (b7) is forced to 1.
Warning code:
On the 8 warning codes of the MODBUS protocol, the MiCOM relay manages two of them:
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0000 Product Relay description 32-127 1 - F10 P120 to P123
Information characters 1 and 2
0001 Relay description 32-127 1 - F10 P1 P120 to P123
characters 3 and 4
0002 Relay description 32-127 1 - F10 23 P120 to P123
characters 5 and 6
0003 Unit reference 32-127 1 - F10 AL P120 to P123
characters 1 and 2
0004 Unit reference 32-127 1 - F10 ST P120 to P123
characters 3 and 4
0005 Software version 10-xx 1 - F21 P120 to P123
0006 Front communication 0-3 1 - F41 P122-P123
0007 Internal phase ratio - F1 P122-P123
0008 Internal earth ratio - F1 P122-P123
0009 to Reserved P120 to P123
000C
000D Real Active Setting 1-2 F1 P122-P123
Group (after taking into
account the protection
flags)
000E Password active* - F24 0 P120 to P123
000F Relay status - F45 P120 to P123
0010 Remote Logical inputs 0 to 7 or 1 - F12 P120 to P123
signalling to 31
0011 Logical data 0 to 2n - F20 P120 to P123
FFFF
0012 Internal Logic 0 to 2n - F22 P120 to P123
FFFF
0013 Output contacts 0 to 127 1 - F13 P120 to P123
or to 511
0014 Output information: I> 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
0015 Output information: 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
I>> FFFF P123
0016 Output information: 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
I>>> FFFF P123
0017 Output information: IE> 0 to 1 - F16 P120 to P123
FFFF
0018 Output information: 0 to 1 - F16 P120 to P123
IE>> FFFF
0019 Output information: 0 to 1 - F16 P120 to P123
IE>>> FFFF
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
001A I> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
001B I>> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
001C I>>> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
001D tI> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
001E tI>> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
001F tI>>> memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P121-P122-
FFFF P123
0020 Thermal state 0 to 1 1 - F37 P122-P123
information
0021 Output information: I< 0 to 1 - F17 P122-P123
FFFF
0022 Output information: 0 to 1 - F16 P122-P123
I2> FFFF
0023 Output information: 0 to 1 - F38 P122-P123
broken conductor FFFF
/ CB failure
/ CB alarm
0024 tI< memorisation 0 to 1 - F17 P122-P123
FFFF
0025 Memorised flag for non - F36 P122-P123
acknowledged alarms
0026 Number of disturbance 0 to 5 1 - F31 P122-P123
records available
0027 Tripping output (RL1) 0 to 1 1 - F1 P122-P123
status
0028 CB supervision flag - F43 P122-P123
0029 memorised flag 2 for - F44 P122-P123
non acknowledged
alarms
002A Reserved Logical 0 to 2n - F20 P120 to P123
data FFFF bis
002B Threshold information: 0 to 1 - F16 P122-P123
Iinv>> FFFF
002C to Reserved P120 to P123
002F
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 11/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0030 Remote Phase A current RMS 0 to 1 A/100 F18 P121-
measurements value 600 000 P122-P123
0032 Phase B current RMS 0 to 1 A/100 F18 P121-
value 600 000 P122-P123
0034 Phase C current RMS 0 to 1 A/100 F18 P121-
value 600 000 P122-P123
0036 Earth current RMS 0 to 1 A/100 F18 P120 to
value 120 000 P123
0038 to Reserved P120 to
0039 P123
003A Thermal state (saved) % F1 P122-P123
003B Frequency 4500 to 1 1/100 F1 P120 to
6500 Hz P123
003C Max RMS value phase 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
A 000
003E Max RMS value phase 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
B 000
0040 Max RMS value phase 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
C 000
0042 Average RMS value 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
Phase A 000
0044 Average RMS value 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
Phase B 000
0046 Average RMS value 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
Phase C 000
0048 Harmonic IO* 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
000
004A Inverse Current 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
(fundamental)
004C Direct current 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
004E I2/I1 ratio % F1 P122-P123
004F Reserved P120 to
P123
0050 Fourier Module IA - F1 P121-
Module P122-P123
0051 Module IB - F1 P121-
P122-P123
0052 Module IC - F1 P121-
P122-P123
0053 Module IE - F1 P120 to
P123
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0054 Fourier Argument IA - F1 P121-P122-
Argument P123
0055 Argument IB - F1 P121-P122-
P123
0056 Argument IC - F1 P121-P122-
P123
0057 Argument IO - F1 P120 to
P123
0058 Module I2** - F1 P122-P123
0059 Module I1** - F1 P122-P123
005A Recloser Cycle total number - F1 P123
statistics
005B Cycle 1 number - F1 P123
005C Cycle 2 number - F1 P123
005D Cycle 3 number - F1 P123
005E Cycle 4 number - F1 P123
005F Definitive tripping - F1 P123
number
0060 Closing order number - F1 P123
0061 Rolling Average sliding time 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
Demand window- RMS IA 000
0063 Average sliding time 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
window- RMS IB 000
0065 Average sliding time 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
window- RMS IC 000
0067 Maximum of the sub 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
period average value 000
RMS phase A
0069 Maximum of the sub 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
period average value 000
RMS phase B
006B Maximum of the sub 0 to 600 1 A/100 F18 P122-P123
period average value 000
RMS phase C
006D to Reserved P122-P123
006F
0070 Output information: 0 to 1 - F54 P123
SOTF FFFF
3.3 Page 1h
Read and write access
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0100 Remote Address 1 to 255 1 - F1 1 P120 to
parameters P123
0101 Reserved P120 to
P123
0102 Password characters 1 32 -127 1 - F10 AA P120 to
and 2 P123
0103 Password characters 3 32 -127 1 - F10 AA P120 to
and 4 P123
0104 Frequency 50-60 10 Hz F1 50 P120 to
P123
0105 Phase A label ** L1-A-R VTA - F25 A P121-
P122-P123
0106 Phase B label ** L2-B-S VTA - F25 B P121-
P122-P123
0107 Phase C label ** L3-C-T VTA - F25 C P121-
P122-P123
0108 Earth label *** N-G-E VTA - F25 N P120 to
P123
0109 Fault display *** 1-4 1 - F26 1 P120 to
P123
010A User reference 32-127 1 F10 AL P120 to
(characters 1 and 2) P123
010B User reference 32-127 1 F10 ST P120 to
(characters 3 and 4) P123
010C Fault number to be 1-5 1 F31 5 P122-P123
displayed
010D Configuration of EDGE 0 F12 0 P122-P123
validation of logic inputs
010E Instantaneous fault 1-5 1 F31 5 P122-P123
number to be displayed
010F Voltage Type applied to 0-1 1 F50 0 P122-P123
the logic inputs
0110 CB monitoring Operation number 1 - F1 P122-P123
measurements
0111 CB Operating time 1 1/100 F1 P122-P123
sec
0112 Switched square Amps An F18 P122-P123
phase A sum
0114 Switched square Amps An F18 P122-P123
phase B sum
0116 Switched square Amps An F18 P122-P123
phase C sum
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 14/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0118 CB Closing time 1/100 F1 P122-P123
sec
0119 to Reserved P120 to
011D P123
011E Maintenance mode P122-P123
011F Relays Latching F14 P121-
P122-P123
0120 Ratio Primary phase CT value 1 to 1 - F1 1000 P121-
50000* P122-P123
0121 Secondary phase CT 1 to 5 4 - F1 1 P121-
value P122-P123
0122 Primary earth CT value 1 to 1 - F1 1000 P120 to
50000* P123
0123 Secondary earth CT 1 to 5 4 - F1 1 P120 to
value P123
0124 to Reserved P120 to
012E P123
012F Rotation phase sequence 0 to 1 1 - F51 0 P121-
P122-P123
0130 Communication Speed 0 to 7 1 - F4 6= P120 to
19200 P123
bds
0131 Parity 0 to 2 1 - F5 0= P120 to
without P123
0132 Data bits 0 to 1 1 - F28 1 = 8 bits P120 to
P123
0133 Stop bit 0 to 1 1 - F29 0=1 P120 to
stop bit P123
0134 COM available 0 to 1 1 - F30 1=COM P120 to
available P123
0135 Date Format 0 to 1 1 - F48 0= P122-P123
Private
0136 to Reserved 0 P120 to
013F P123
0140 Configuration Setting group 1 to 2 1 - F1 1 P122-P123
0141 Validation of 0 to 1 1 - F1 0 P122-P123
instantaneous alarms
auto reset
0142 Configuration of change 0 to 1 1 - F47 1 P122-P123
of group selection
0143 Battery alarm and RAM 0 to 1 1 - F1 0 P122-P123
error configuration
0144 Configuration of LED 0 to 1 1 F1 0 P122-P123
reset on fault
0145 to Reserved 0 P120 to
0149 P123
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 15/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
014A Output Relay Max I2>> 0 to 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
allocation
014B to Reserved P120 to
014F P123
0150 LEDs Led 5 1 - F19 4 P120 to
allocation P123
0151 Led 6 1 - F19 16 P120 to
P123
0152 Led 7 1 - F19 32 P120 to
P123
0153 Led 8 1 F19 64 P120 to
P123
0154 Led PF 5 1 F19' 0 P122-P123
0155 Led PF 6 1 F19' 0 P122-P123
0156 Led PF 7 1 F19' 0 P122-P123
0157 Led PF 8 1 F19' 0 P122-P123
0158 to Reserved P122-P123
015A
015B Logic input Logic input 1 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
allocation Bis
015C Logic input 2 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
Bis
015D Logic input 3 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
Bis
015E Logic input 4 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
Bis
015F Logic input 5 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
Bis
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0160 Logic input Logic input 1 VTA - F15 0 P120 to
allocation P123
0161 Logic input 2 VTA - F15 0 P120 to
P123
0162 Logic input 3 VTA - F15 0 P122-P123
0163 Logic input 4 VTA - F15 0 P123
0164 Logic input 5 VTA - F15 0 P123
0165 Output relay Broken conductor 0-31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
allocation detection
0166 CB failure 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
0167 I< 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
0168 I2> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
0169 Thermal overload alarm 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
016A Thermal overload trip 0-31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
016B CB close 0-31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
016C tAUX1 0-31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
016D tAUX2 0-31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
016E CB alarms 0-31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
016F Trip circuit 0-31 1 - F14 0 P123
0170 Active setting group 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
If active group =2 than
output =1
0171 Trip 0 - 31 1 - F14 1 P120 to
P123
0172 tI> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
0173 tI>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
0174 tI>>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
0175 tIE> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
0176 tIE>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
0177 tIE>>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
0178 I> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
0179 I>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
017A I>>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P121-
P122-P123
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 17/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
017B IE> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
017C IE>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
017D IE>>> 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P120 to
P123
017E Recloser running 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P123
017F Recloser final trip 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P123
0180 Automation Trip 0 to 63 1 - F6 1 P120 to
P123
0181 Relay latching 0 to 63 1 - F8 0 P120 to
P123
0182 Blocking logic 1 0 to 63 1 - F8' 0 P120 to
P123
0183 Blocking logic 2 0 to 63 1 - F8' 0 P122-P123
0184 Broken conductor 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
detection
0185 tBC 0 to 14400 1 - F1 0 P122-P123
0186 Cold load start 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0187 Cold load start thresholds 0 to 255 1 - F33 0 P122-P123
0188 Cold load start % 100 to 500 1 F1 50 P122-P123
0189 Cold load start delay 1 to 36000* 1 1/10 s F1 10 P122-P123
018A CB failure 0-1 1 F24 0 P122-P123
018B tBF 0 to 1000 1 1/100 F1 10 P122-P123
s
018C Logic Selectivity1 0 to 15 1 - F40 0 P122-P123
018D tSEL1 0 to 15000 1 1/100 F1 0 P122-P123
s
018E Logic Selectivity2 0 to 15 1 - F40 0 P122-P123
018F tSEL2 0 to 15000 1 1/100 F1 0 P122-P123
s
0190 Disturbance Pre-time 1 to 30 1 - F1 1 P122-P123
0191 Post-time 1 to 30 1 - F1 1 P122-P123
0192 Disturbance starting 0-1 1 - F32 0 P122-P123
condition
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0193 CB monitoring Operating time 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0194 Operating time threshold 5 to 100 5 1/100 s F1 5 P122-P123
0195 Operation number 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0196 Operation number 0 - 50000 1 - F1 0 P122-P123
threshold
0197 CB switched Amps sum 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
(Power n)
0198 CB switched Amps sum 0 to 10E6 An F3 P122-P123
threshold 4000
0199 Amps or square Amps 1-2 1 F1 1 P122-P123
019A Closing time threshold 5 to 100 5 1/100 s F1 0 P122-P123
019B Auxiliary timer 1 0 to 20000 1 1/100 s F1 0 P122-P123
019C Auxiliary timer 2 0 to 20000 1 1/100 s F1 0 P122-P123
019D Peak value 5 to 60 VTA min F42 5 P122-P123
019E I2/I1 threshold 20 to 100 1 % F1 20 P122-P123
019F Tripping time 10 to 500 5 1/100 s F1 10 P122-P123
01A0 Closing time 10 to 500 5 1/100 s F1 10 P122-P123
01A1 Closing time threshold 0-1 1 F24 0 P122-P123
validation
01A2 Trip circuit supervision 0-1 1 F24 0 P122-P123
validation
01A3 t SUP 10 to 1000 5 1/100 s F1 10 P122-P123
01A4 I< threshold CB failure 10 - 100 1 %In F1 10 P122-P123
01A5 Instantaneous phase 0–1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
blocking if CB failure
01A6 Instantaneous earth 0–1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
blocking if CB failure
01A7 Rolling Sub period 0 – 60 1 min F1 P122-P123
Demand
01A8 Sub period number 0 – 24 1 - F1 P122-P123
01A9 Output relay Communication Order 1* 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
allocation
01AA Communication Order 2* 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
01AB Communication Order 3* 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
01AC Communication Order 4* 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
01AD T comm 1* 10 – 500 5 1/100s F1 10 P122-P123
01AE T comm 2* 10 – 500 5 1/100s F1 10 P122-P123
01AF T comm 3* 10 – 500 5 1/100s F1 10 P122-P123
01B0 T comm 4* 10 – 500 5 1/100s F1 10 P122-P123
01B1 tEXT 3 0 – 31 1 - F14 0 P122-P123
01B2 tEXT 4 0 – 31 1 - F14 0 P123
01B3 Auxiliary timer3 0 – 20000 1 1/100s F1 0 P122-P123
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 19/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
01B4 Auxiliary timer4 0 – 20000 1 1/100s F1 0 P123
01B5 to Reserved P120 to
01BF P123
01C0 to Reserved ** P123
01F5
01F6 Remote trip** 0 – 31 1 - F14 0 P123
01F7 Remote close** 0 – 31 1 - F14 0 P123
01F8 SOFT function** 0–1 1 - F52 0 P123
01F9 SOFT timer** 0 - 500 1 1/1000s F1 0 P123
01FA SOFT parameter I>> or 0-1 1 - F53 0 P123
I>>>**
01FB Trip bis** 0 to 63 1 - F6’ 0 P123
01FC Relay latching bis** 0 to 63 1 - F7 0 P123
01FD Output relay SOFT** 0 - 31 1 - F14 0 P123
allocation
* From V5.D
** From V6.C
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 20/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0200 Setting group I> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P121-P122-
1 P123
0201 I> threshold 10 to 2500 1 In/100 F1 10 P121-P122-
P123
0202 I> time delay type 0 to 2 1 - F27 0 P121-P122-
P123
0203 I> IDMT Curve Type 0 to 10 1 - F3 1 P121-P122-
P123
0204 I> TMS value 25 to 1500 25 1/1000 F1 25 P121-P122-
P123
0205 I> K value (RI curve) 100 to 10000 5 1/1000 F1 100 P121-P122-
P123
0206 tI> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P121-P122-
P123
0207 I> Reset type 0-1 1 F27 0 P122-P123
0208 I> RTMS value 25 to 3200 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0209 I> tRESET value 4 to 10000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P122-P123
020A to Reserved 0 P120 to
020F P123
0210 I>> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P121-P122-
P123
0211 I>> Threshold 50 to 4000 5 In/100 F1 50 P121-P122-
P123
0212 tI>> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P121-P122-
P123
0213 I>> time delay type 0–2 1 - F27 0 P122-P123
0214 I>> IDMT curve type 0 – 10 1 - F3 1 P122-P123
0215 I>> TMS value 25 – 1500 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0216 K value (RI curve) 100 – 10000 5 1/1000 F1 100 P122-P123
0217 I>> Reset Type 0–1 1 - F27 0 P122-P123
0218 I>> RTMS value 25 – 3200 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0219 I>> tRESET value 4 – 10000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P122-P123
021A to Reserved 0 P120 to
021F P123
0220 I>>> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P121-P122-
P123
0221 I>>> Threshold 50 to 4000 5 In/100 F1 50 P121-P122-
P123
0222 tI>>> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P121-P122-
P123
0223 I>>> on sample 0–1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0223 to Reserved 0 P120 to
022F P123
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 21/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0230 IE> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P120 to
P123
0231 IE> Threshold 10 to 1000 5 1/1000 F1 10 P120 to
I0n P123
0232 IE> time delay type 0 to 3 1 - F27’ 0 P120 to
P123
0233 IE> IDMT curve type 0 to 10 1 - F3 1 P120 to
P123
0234 IE> TMS value 25 to 1500 25 1/1000 F1 25 P120 to
P123
0235 IE> K value (RI curve) 100 to 10000 5 1/1000 F1 100 P120 to
P123
0236 tIE> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P120 to
P123
0237 IE> reset type 0-1 1 F27 0 P122-P123
0238 IE> RTMS value 25 to 3200 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0239 IE> tRESET value 4 to 10000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P122-P123
023A IE> Curve type 0–2 0 1 F3’ 0 P122-P123
(Belgium)
023B to Reserved P120 to
023F P123
0240 IE>> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P120 to
P123
0241 IE>> Threshold 10 to 8000 5 1/1000 F1 10 P120 to
I0n P123
0242 tIE>> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P120 to
P123
0243 IE>> time delay type 0 to 3 1 - F27’ 0 P122-P123
0244 IE>> IDMT curve type 0 to 10 1 - F3 1 P122-P123
0245 IE>> TMS value 25 to 1500 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0246 IE>> K value 100 to 10000 5 1/1000 F1 100 P122-P123
(RI curve)
0247 TReset Type 0–1 1 - F27 0 P122-P123
0248 Time Multiplier 25 – 3200 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
TDMS
0249 TReset 4 – 10000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P122-P123
024A Curve Type 0–2 0 1 F3’ 0 P122-P123
(Belgium)
024B to Reserved 0 P120 to
024E P123
024F IE>> on sample 0–1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0250 IE>>> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P120 to
P123
0251 IE>>> Threshold 10 to 8000 5 1/1000 F1 10 P120 to
I0n P123
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 22/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0252 tIE>>>value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P120 to
P123
0253 Ith> 0-1 1 F24 0 P122-P123
0254 Ith> Threshold 10 to 320 5 1/100 F1 8 P122-P123
0255 Ith> k value 100 to 150 1 1/100 F1 105 P122-P123
0256 Ith> trip threshold 50 to 200 1 % F1 100 P122-P123
0257 Ith> alarm 0-1 1 F24 0 P122-P123
0258 Ith> alarm threshold 50 to 200 1 % F1 90 P122-P123
0259 Thermal overload time 1 to 200 1 mn F1 1 P122-P123
constant
025A I< 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
025B I< threshold 0 to 100 1 % In F1 20 P122-P123
025C I2> 0-1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
025D I2> threshold 10 to 4000 1 In/100 F1 10 P122-P123
025E I2> time delay type 0 to 2 1 - F27 0 P122-P123
025F I2> IDMT type 0 to 9 1 - F3 1 P122-P123
0260 I2> TMS value 25 to 1500 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0261 I2> K value (RI) 100 to 10000 5 1/1000 F1 100 P122-P123
0262 tI2> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 P122-P123
0263 I2> Reset type 0-1 1 F27 0 P122-P123
0264 I2> RTMS value 25 to 3200 25 1/1000 F1 25 P122-P123
0265 I2> tRESET value 4 to 10000 1 1/100 s F1 4 P122-P123
0266 Iinv>> 0–1 1 - F24 0 P122-P123
0267 Iinv>> Threshold 10 – 4000 1 1/100 In F24 10 P122-P123
0268 tIinv>> value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 P122-P123
0269 to Reserved 0 P120 to
026E P123
026F tI< value 0 to 15000 1 1/100 s F1 P122-P123
0270 AR Recloser valid 0-1 1 F24 0 P123
0271 CB position active 0-1 1 F1 0 P123
0272- Supervision window 1 to 60000 1 1/100 s F18 1 P123
0273
0274 External blocking input 0 – 1 1 F24 0 P123
0275 to Reserved P120 to
0276 P123
0277 Dead time 1 0 to 30000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P123
0278 Dead time 2 0 to 30000 1 1/100 s F1 1 P123
0279- Dead time 3 0 to 60000 1 1/100 s F18 1 P123
027A
027B- Dead time 4 0 to 60000 1 1/100 s F18 1 P123
027C
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 23/168
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
027D- Reclaim time 2 to 60000 1 1/100 s F18 2 P123
027E
027F- Inhibit time 2 to 60000 1 1/100 s F18 2 P123
0280
0281 Recloser cycles for 0 to 4 1 F1 0 P123
phase faults
0282 Recloser cycles for 0 to 4 1 F1 0 P123
earth faults
0283 I> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0284 I>> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0285 I>>> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0286 IE> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0287 IE>> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0288 IE>>> Phase cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
0289 TAUX1 cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
028A TAUX2 cycle 0 – 2222 1 F49 0 P123
configuration
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 24/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
3.6 Page 4h
Access in writing
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format Range
range Value
0400 Remote Remote control word 1 0 to 31 1 - F9 0 P120 to
control P123
0401 Reserved 0 P120 to
P123
0402 Remote control word 2 0 to 511 1 - F39 0 P122-P123
(single output command)
0403 Remote control word 3 0 to 1 1 - F46 0 P122-P123
3.8 Page 7h
Access in quick reading only (MODBUS 07 function)
Values Fault
Address Group Description Step Unit Format
range Value
0700 Quick Description of the 1 - F23 0
reading byte protection autocontrol
Addresses Contents
0900h to 09FAh 250 disturbance data words
0A00h to 0AFAh 250 disturbance data words
0B00h to 0BFAh 250 disturbance data words
0C00h to 0CFAh 250 disturbance data words
0D00h to 0DFAh 250 disturbance data words
0E00h to 0EFAh 250 disturbance data words
0F00h to 0FFAh 250 disturbance data words
1000h to 10FAh 250 disturbance data words
1100h to 11FAh 250 disturbance data words
1200h to 12FAh 250 disturbance data words
1300h to 13FAh 250 disturbance data words
1400h to 14FAh 250 disturbance data words
1500h to 15FAh 250 disturbance data words
1600h to 16FAh 250 disturbance data words
1700h to 17FAh 250 disturbance data words
1800h to 18FAh 250 disturbance data words
1900h to 19FAh 250 disturbance data words
1A00h to 1AFAh 250 disturbance data words
1B00h to 1BFAh 250 disturbance data words
1C00h to 1CFAh 250 disturbance data words
1D00h to 1DFAh 250 disturbance data words
1E00h to 1EFAh 250 disturbance data words
1F00h to 1FFAh 250 disturbance data words
2000h to 20FAh 250 disturbance data words
2100h to 21FAh 250 disturbance data words
NB: The disturbance data pages contain values of one channel from one
given disturbance record.
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 31/168
• Frequency channel:
Time between two samples in microseconds
• Logic channels:
Addresses Contents
2200h Disturbance data index frame
Word Contents
n° 1 Disturbance record number
n° 2 Disturbance record finish date (second)
n° 3 Disturbance record finish date (second)
n° 4 Disturbance record finish date (millisecond)
n° 5 Disturbance record finish date (millisecond)
n° 6 Disturbance record starting condition:
1: tripping command (RL1)
2: instantaneous
3: remote command
4: logic input
n° 7 Frequency at the post-time beginning
n° 8 (=0) Optional
n° 9 (=0) Optional
MODBUS COURIER
Code Meaning of the event Type
address Cell
00 No event - -
01 Remote closing F9 013h 021
02 Remote tripping F9 013h 021
03 Disturbance recording start F9 -
04 Trip output delatch F9 013h 021
05 Setting change Address -
06 Remote thermal reset F9 -
07 Maintenance Mode F9 ↑ ↓ 0400h -
08 Control relay in maintenance mode F39 ↑ ↓ 013h -
09 I> F17 ↑ ↓ 014h 023
10 I>> F17 ↑ ↓ 015h 023
11 I>>> F17 ↑ ↓ 016h 023
12 IE> F16 ↑ ↓ 017h 023
13 IE>> F16 ↑ ↓ 018h 023
14 IE>>> F16 ↑ ↓ 019h 023
15 Thermal overload alarm F37 ↑ ↓ 020h 023
16 Thermal overload threshold F37 ↑ ↓ 020h 023
17 tI> F17 ↑ ↓ 014h 023
18 tI>> F17 ↑ ↓ 015h 023
19 tI>>> F17 ↑ ↓ 016h 023
20 tIE> F16 ↑ ↓ 017h 023
21 tIE>> F16 ↑ ↓ 018h 023
22 tIE>>> F16 ↑ ↓ 019h 023
23 tI< F16 ↑ ↓ 021h 023
24 Broken conductor F38 ↑ ↓ 023h 024
25 t Aux 1 F38 ↑ ↓ 023h 024
26 t Aux 2 F38 ↑ ↓ 023h 024
27 CB failure F38 ↑ ↓ 023h 024
28 Selective scheme logic 1 F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
29 Selective scheme logic 2 F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
30 Blocking logic 1 F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
31 Blocking logic 2 F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
32 Setting group change F20 011h 020
33 52a F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
34 52b F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
35 Acknowledgement of the output F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
relay latched, by logic input,
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 34/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
MODBUS COURIER
Code Meaning of the event Type
address Cell
36 SF6 F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
37 Cold load start F20 ↑ ↓ 011h 020
38 Change of input logic state F12 ↑ ↓ 010h 020
39 Thermal overload trip F37 013h 021
40 tI> trip F13 013h 021
41 tI>> trip F13 013h 021
42 tI>>> trip F13 013h 021
43 tIE> trip F13 013h 021
44 tIE>> trip F13 013h 021
45 tIE>>> trip F13 013h 021
46 tI< trip F13 013h 021
47 Broken conductor trip F13 013h 021
48 tAUX 1 trip F13 013h 021
49 tAUX 2 trip F13 013h 021
50 Output relays command F39 ↑ ↓ 013h 021
51 Front panel single alarm acknowl. - -
52 Front panel all alarms acknowledge - -
53 Remote single alarm acknowledge - -
54 Remote all alarms acknowledge - -
55 Major material alarm F45 ↑ ↓ 00Fh 022
56 Minor material alarm F45 ↑ ↓ 00Fh 022
57 I2> F16 ↑ ↓ 022h 024
58 tI2> F16 ↑ ↓ 022h 024
59 Operation time F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
60 Operation numbers F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
61 Sum of switched square amps F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
62 Trip circuit supervision F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
63 Closing time F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
64 Reclose successful F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
65 Recloser locked F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
66 Recloser settings error or F43 ↑ ↓ 028h 024
configuration error
67 I2> trip F16 ↑ ↓ 013h 021
68 General Starting
69 Reclosure in service
70 CB Closed by autoreclosure
71 Relays latching
72 External CB failure
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 35/168
MODBUS COURIER
Code Meaning of the event Type
address Cell
73 I< F16 ↑ ↓ 021h 023
74 I2>> F16 ↑ ↓ 022h 024
75 tI2>> F16 ↑ ↓ 022h 024
76 I2>> Trip F16 ↑ ↓ 013h 021
77 Reserved
78 Latching Trip Relay (RL1)
79 t AUX3 F38 023h 025
80 t AUX3 TRIP F13 013h 021
81 t AUX4 F38 023h 025
82 t AUX4 TRIP F13 013h 021
83 t Reset I> F17 ↑ ↓ 014h 025
84 t Reset I>> F17 ↑ ↓ 015h 025
85 t Reset Ie> F16 ↑ ↓ 017h 025
86 t Reset Ie>> F16 ↑ ↓ 018h 025
87 t Reset I2> F16 ↑ ↓ 022h 025
88 TRIP Breaker Failure
Addresses Contents
3600h Most older event data
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 36/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Addresses Contents
3700h Fault value record n°1
3701h Fault value record n°2
3702h Fault value record n°3
3703h Fault value record n°4
3704h Fault value record n°5
Addresses Contents
3E00h Most older Fault record
Addresses Contents
3D00h Number of disturbance records available
CODE DESCRIPTION
F1 Unsigned integer – numerical data: 65535
F2 Signed integer – numerical data: -32768 – 32767
F3 Unsigned integer – curves type
0: STI (IEC)
1: SI (IEC)
2: VI (IEC)
3: EI (IEC)
4: LTI (IEC)
5: STI (C02)
6: MI (ANSI)
7: LTI (CO8)
8: VI (ANSI)
9: EI (ANSI)
10: RC (IEC) Rectifier curve
F3’ Unsigned integer –Belgium curves type for Earth sensitive version
0: Network 1 (Laborellec)
1: Network 2 (Laborellec)
2: source 3 (Laborellec)
F4 Unsigned integer: MODBUS speed
0: 300
1: 600
2: 1200
3: 2400
4: 4800
5: 9600
6: 19200
7: 38400
F5 Unsigned integer: parity
0: without
1: even
2: odd
F6 Unsigned integer: Tripping configuration
bit 0: tI>
bit 1: tI>>
bit 2: tI>>>
bit 3: tIE>
bit 4: tIE>>
bit 5: tIE>>>
bit 6: I<
bit 7: tIth>
bit 8: Broken conductor detection
bit 9: t Aux 1
bit 10: t Aux 2
bit 11: tI2>
bit 12: tI2>>
bit 13: t Aux 3
bit 14: t Aux 4
bit 15: Breaker Failure
F6’ Unsigned integer: Tripping configuration
bit 0: SOFT
bit 1: Remote Trip
bit 2 to 15: Reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 42/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CODE DESCRIPTION
F7 Unsigned integer: Latching configuration
bit 0: SOFT
bit 1 to 15: Reserved
F8 Unsigned integer: Latching configuration
bit 0: I> latching
bit 1: I>>
bit 2: I>>>
bit 3: IE>
bit 4: IE>>
bit 5: IE>>>
bit 6: I<
bit 7: tIth>
bit 8: Broken conductor detection
bit 9: t Aux 1
bit 10: t Aux 2
bit 11: tI2>
bit 12: tI2>>
bit 13: t Aux 3
bit 14: t Aux 4
bit 15: Breaker Failure
F8' Unsigned integer: Blocking logic configuration
bit 0: I> blocking
bit 1: I>>
bit 2: I>>>
bit 3: IE>
bit 4: IE>>
bit 5: IE>>>
bit 6: reserved
bit 7: tIth>
bit 8: Broken conductor detection
bit 9: t Aux 1
bit 10: t Aux 2
bit 11: tI2>
bit 12: tI2>>
bit 13: t Aux 3
bit 14: t Aux 4
bit 15: reserved
F9 Unsigned integer: Remote control 1
bit 0: Tripping contact delatched
bit 1: 1st alarm acknowledge
bit 2: All alarms acknowledge
bit 3: Remote tripping
bit 4: Remote closing
bit 5: Setting group change
bit 6: Thermal state reset
bit 7: Peak and rolling value reset
bit 8: Disturbance record remote start
bit 9: Maintenance mode
bit 10: Recloser counter reset
bit 11: Recloser reset
bit 12: Local manual acknowledge
bit 13: Oldest event acknowledge
bit 14: Oldest fault acknowledge
bit 15: Hardware RAM alarm acknowledge
F10 2 characters ASCII
32 –127 = ASCII character1
32 – 127 = ASCII character 2
F11 Reserved
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 43/168
CODE DESCRIPTION
F12 Unsigned integer: Logic input status
bit 0: logic input number 1
bit 1: logic input number 2
bit 2: logic input number 3
bit 3: logic input number 4
bit 4: logic input number 5
bits 5 to 15: reserved
F13 Unsigned integer: logic outputs status
bit 0: logic output number RL1 (tripping)
bit 1: logic output number RL2
bit 2: logic output number RL3
bit 3: logic output number RL4
bit 4: logic output number RL0 (watchdog)
bit 5: logic output number RL5
bit 6: logic output number RL6
bit 7: logic output number RL7
bit 8: logic output number RL8
bits 9 to 15: reserved
F14 Unsigned integer: logic outputs configuration
bit 0: selection logic output number RL2
bit 1: selection logic output number RL3
bit 2: selection logic output number RL4
bit 3: selection logic output number RL5
bit 4: selection logic output number RL6
bit 5: selection logic output number RL7
bit 6: selection logic output number RL8
F15 Unsigned integer: logical input allocation
bit 0: delatch allocation
bit 1: allocation 52 a
bit 2: allocation 52 b
bit 3: allocation Lack of SF6
bit 4: allocation external input 1
bit 5: allocation external input 2
bit 6: allocation logic blocking 1
bit 7: allocation logic blocking 2
bit 8: allocation disturbance start
bit 9: allocation cold load start
bit 10: allocation selective scheme logic 1
bit 11 allocation selective scheme logic 2
bit 12: allocation change of setting group
bit 13: allocation recloser locked
bit 14: allocation thermal state reset
bit 15: allocation trip circuit supervision
F15bis bit 0: allocation Circuit Breaker Failure
bit 1: Reset of LEDs alarms
bit 2: Maintenance mode
bit 3: allocation external input 3
bit 4: allocation external input 4
bit 5: SOFT/TOR (from V6.C)
bit 6: Local/remote (from V6.C)
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 44/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CODE DESCRIPTION
F16 Unsigned integer: threshold earth information status
bit 0: information threshold exceeded (IE> or IE>> or IE>>>)
bit 1: reserved
bit 2: reserved
bit 3: reserved
bit 4: reserved
bit 5: Instantaneous information IE> or IE>> or IE>>>
bit 6: Tripping information tIE> or tIE>> or tIE>>>
bits 7 to 15: reserved
F17 Unsigned integer: threshold phase information status
bit 0: information thresold exceeded (I>, I>>, I>>>)
bit 1: Instantaneous IA
bit 2: Instantaneous IB
bit 3: Instantaneous IC
bit 4: reserved
bit 5: Instantaneous information I> or I>> or I>>>
bit 6: Tripping information tI> or tI>> or tI>>>
bits 7 to 15: reserved
F18 Long integer
F19 Unsigned integer: LEDs allocation
bit 0: I>
bit 1: tI>
bit 2: I>>
bit 3: tI>>
bit 4: I>>>
bit 5: tI>>>
bit 6: IE>
bit 7: tIE>
bit 8: IE>>
bit 9: tIE>>
bit 10: IE>>>
bit 11: tIE>>>
bit 12: Thermal overload trip
bit 13: tI2>
bit 14: Broken conductor trip
bit 15: CB failure
bit 16: Logic input 1
bit 17: Logic input 2
bit 18: Logic input 3
bit 19: Logic input 4
bit 20: Logic input 5
bit 21: Recloser running
bit 22: Recloser locked
bit 23: tAUX1
bit 24: tAUX2
bit 25: tI2>>
bit 26: SOFT (from V6.C)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 45/168
CODE DESCRIPTION
F20 Unsigned integer: logic input data status
bit 0: Selective scheme logic 1
bit 1: Selective scheme logic 2
bit 2: Relay delatch
bit 3: CB position (52 a)
bit 4: CB position (52 b)
bit 5: Lack of SF6
bit 6: External 1
bit 7: External 2
bit 8: Blocking logic 1
bit 9: Blocking logic 2
bit 10: Disturbance record start
bit 11: Cold load start
bit 12: Setting group change
bit 13: Recloser locked
bit 14: Thermal state reset
bit 15: Trip circuit supervision
F20 bis bit 0: CB Failure by external signalisation
bit 1: LEDs alarms reset
bit 2: maintenance mode
F21 Unsigned integer: software version
10: Version 1.A
11: Version 1.B
20: Version 2.A
CODE DESCRIPTION
F30 0: Communication non-available
1: Communication available
F31 Unsigned integer: Number of available event records
0: None
1: 1 event record available
2: 2 event records available
3: 3 event records available
4: 4 event records available
5: 5 event records available
F32 Unsigned integer:
0: Disturbance record start condition on INSTANTANEOUS
1: Disturbance record start condition on TRIPPING
F33 Cold load start thresholds
bit 0: tI>
bit 1: tI>>
bit 2: tI>>>
bit 3: tIE>
bit 4: tIE>>
bit 5: tIE>>>
bit 6: Thermal overload trip
bit 7: tI2>
bit 8: tI2>>
bit 9 to 15: reserved
F34 Reserved
F35 0: No disturbance record uploaded
1: Disturbance record upload running
F36 Memorised flags of non acknowledged alarms:
bit 0: IE>
bit 1: tIE>
bit 2: IE>>
bit 3: tIE>>
bit 4: IE>>>
bit 5: tIE>>>
bit 6: Thermal overload alarm
bit 7: Thermal overload trip
bit 8: Broken conductor
bit 9: CB failure
bit 10: I2>>
bit 11: I2>
bit 12: tI2>
bit 13: t Aux 1
bit 14: t Aux 2
bit 15: tI2>>
F37 Unsigned integer: Thermal overload information
bit 0: Thermal overload alarm
bit 1: Thermal overload trip
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 47/168
CODE DESCRIPTION
F38 Unsigned integer:
bit 0: reserved
bit 1: CB failure
bit 2: Pole A opening
bit 3: Pole B opening
bit 4: Pole C opening
bit 5: Broken conductor
bit 6: t Aux 1
bit 7: t Aux 2
bit 8: Broken conductor time delay
bit 9: CB failure time delay
bit 10: Cold load pick up time delay
bit 11: CB alarms or bits 0,1,2,4 of F43
bit 12: t Aux 3
bit 13: t Aux 4
F39 Unsigned integer: output relay remote word in maintenance mode
bit 0: RL1 (trip)
bit 1: RL2
bit 2: RL3
bit 3: RL0 (watch-dog)
bit 4: RL4
bit 5: RL5
bit 6: RL6
bit 7: RL7
bit 8: RL8
F40 Unsigned integer: selective scheme logic configuration
bit 0: tI>>
bit 1: tI>>>
bit 2: tIE>>
bit 3: tIE>>>
F41 0: Front and rear MODBUS communication
1: Front MODBUS and rear Courier communication
2: Front MODBUS and rear IEC103 communication
3: Front MODBUS and rear DNP3 communication
F42 5, 10, 15, 30 or 60 minutes
F43 bit 0: CB operating time overreach
bit 1: CB operation number overreach
bit 2: Square Amps sum overreach
bit 3: Trip circuit self-test
bit 4: CB closing time overreach
bit 5: Recloser locked
bit 6: Recloser successful
bit 7: Recloser running
bit 8: Closing command issued from recloser cycle
bit 9: Recloser configuration error
bit 10: Only for VDEW: reclosure in service
F44 bit 0: CB, operating time overreach, memorised alarm
bit 1: CB operation number overreach, memorised alarm
bit 2: Square Amps sum overreach, memorised alarm
bit 3: Trip circuit self-test, memorised alarm
bit 4: CB closing time overreach, memorised alarm
Bit 5: t Aux 3, Memorised alarm
Bit 6: t Aux 4, Memorised alarm
Bit 7: reserved
bit 8: SOFT
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 48/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CODE DESCRIPTION
F45 Unsigned integer: relay status
bit 0: Watchdog
bit 1: Communication failure
bit 2: EEPROM data failure
bit 3: Analogue failure
bit 4: Datation failure
bit 5: EEPROM calibration failure
bit 6: SRAM failure
bit 7: Battery failure
bit 8 to 15: reserved
F46 bit 0: Launching IO harmonic calculation
bit 1: internally reserved for delatching of tripping relay only (RL1), and not like
bit 0 in F9.
bit 2: Acknowledgement of the oldest disturbance record
bit 3: End of maintenance mode
bit 4: Reset of Rolling Demands Data (average avlues and timers)
bit 5: Reset of maximum values of the averages in sub period
bit 6: LEDs reset
bit 7: Internal reset of non latched tripping LED
bit 8: communication Order 1
bit 9: communication Order 2
bit 10: communication Order 3
bit 11: communication Order 4
F47 0: user wishes working on EDGE (Rising or Falling) of the logic inputs
(configuration can be done by communication or by the front panel)
1: user wishes working on LEVEL (High or Low) of the logic inputs
F48 0: Private Format Date
1: IEC Format Date
F49 bit 0: Cycle 1 configuration ( trip and initialise the reclosure)
bit 1: Cycle 1 configuration ( block the tripping on cycle )
bit 2, 3: reserved
bit 4: Cycle 2 configuration ( trip and initialise the reclosure)
bit 5: Cycle 2 configuration ( block the tripping on cycle )
bit 6, 7: reserved
bit 8: Cycle 3 configuration ( trip and initialise the reclosure)
bit 9: Cycle 3 configuration ( block the tripping on cycle )
bit 10, 11: reserved
bit 12: Cycle 4 configuration ( trip and initialise the reclosure)
bit 13: Cycle 4 configuration ( block the tripping on cycle )
F50 0: DC Voltage
1: AC Voltage
F51 0: Direct phase rotation ABC
1: Inverse phase rotation ACB
F52 Status of SOFT functions (Switch On To Fault)
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
F53 SOFT parameters
0: Start I>>
1: Start I>>>
F54 Bit 0: SOFT in progress
Bit 1: Instantaneous information
Bit 2: Tripping information
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 49/168
This request may be answered an error message with the error code:
EVT_NOK(OF): No record available
NOTA: If there is less than 5 records available, the answer will contains zero
in the non-used words.
4.1.3 Service requests
This request must be send before uploading the disturbance record channel samples. It
allows to know the record number and the channel number to upload. It allows also to know
the number of samples in the channel.
This request may be answered an error message with two different error codes:
CODE_DEF_RAM(02): SRAM failure
CODE_EVT_NOK(03): No disturbance record available in SRAM
4.1.4 Disturbance record upload request
This request may be answered an error message with two different error codes:
CODE_DEP_DATA(04): The required disturbance data number is
greater than the memorised number.
CODE_SERV_NOK(05): The service request for disturbance record and
channel number has not been send.
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Modbus Database
Page 50/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
This event request may be answered an error message with the error code:
EVT_EN_COURS_ECRIT (5): An event is being written into the saved RAM.
NOTE: On event retrieval, two possibilities exist regarding the event record
acknowledgement:
a) Automatic event record acknowledgement on event retrieval.
b) Non automatic event record acknowledgement on event
retrieval.
a) Automatic event record acknowledgement on event retrieval:
The bit12 of the remote order frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 0.
On event retrieval, this event record is acknowledged.
b) Non automatic event record acknowledgement on event retrieval:
The bit12 of the remote order frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 1.
On event retrieval, this event record is not acknowledged.
To acknowledge this event, an other remote order shall be sent to the relay. The bit 13 of
this frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 1.
4.1.7 Request to retrieve a dedicated event
This event request may be answered an error message with the error code:
EVT_EN_COURS_ECRIT (5): An event is being written into the saved RAM.
NOTA: This event retrieval does not acknowledge this event.
4.1.8 Modbus request definition used to retrieve the fault records
Two ways can be followed to retrieve a fault record:
Send a request to retrieve the oldest non-acknowledge fault record.
Send a request to retrieve a dedicated fault record.
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Modbus Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 51/168
NOTA: On fault retrieval, two possibilities exist regarding the fault record
acknowledgement:
a) Automatic fault record acknowledgement on event retrieval.
b) Non automatic fault record acknowledgement on event
retrieval.
a) Automatic fault record acknowledgement on fault retrieval:
The bit12 of the remote order frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 0.
On fault retrieval, this fault record is acknowledged.
b) Non automatic fault record acknowledgement on fault retrieval:
The bit12 of the remote order frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 1.
On fault retrieval, this fault record is not acknowledged.
To acknowledge this fault, an other remote order shall be sent to the relay. The bit 14 of this
frame (format F9 – mapping address 0400h) shall be set to 1.
4.1.10 Request to retrieve a dedicated fault record
NOTA: This fault value retrieval does not acknowledge this fault record.
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
COURIER DATABASE
MiCOM P120 - P121 - P122 - P123
VERSION V6.E
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 1/168
CONTENT
BLANK PAGE
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 3/168
The following table presents the list of the protection indications of the cell 0024:
• Alarm condition
• Setting Change
• Cell Reference
• Timestamp
• Cell Text
• Cell Value
Paragraph 2 contains a table of the events created by the relay and indicates how the
contents of the above fields are interpreted. Fault records will return a Courier Type 3 event
which contains the above fields together with two additional fields:
• Event number
These events contain additional information which is extracted from the relay using the
referenced extraction column. Row 01 of the extraction column contains a setting which
allows the fault record to be selected. This setting should be set to the event number value
returned within the record, the extended data can be extracted from the relay by uploading
the text and data from the column.
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 9/168
NOTA: When the cell reference is different of zero this means that the event
is generated on event occurrence and another is generated on event
disappearance.
When the cell reference is equal to zero, only the event on edging edge is generated.
Twelve bits are available in the string of characters to describe the contain of the Courier
cell:
On event occurrence, the corresponding bit of the associated format is set to « 1 ».
On event disappearance, the corresponding bit of the associated format is set to « 0 ».
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 13/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
10 Circuit Breaker Control Binary flag (3 bits) 0: No operation Data
1: Trip
2: Close
11 Software Reference ASCII Text (16 characters) Data
12-1F Unused, reserved
20 Logic Input Status Binary flag (3 bits) 0: log input 1 Data
1: log input 2
21 Relay Output Status Binary flag (5 bits) 0: relay 1 (trip) Data
1: relay 2
2: relay 3
3: relay 4
4: watchdog relay
22 Alarm Binary flag (16 bits) 0: Ana output err Data
1: Comm err
2: Eeprom err data
3: Ct error
4: reserved
5: Eeprom err calib
6: reserved
7: reserved
8: reserved
9: Default settings
10 to 15: reserved
23 Pseudo Logic Input Binary flag (12 bits) 3: I0> Data
Status group 1 4: I0>>
5: I0>>>
9: t I0>
10: t I0>>
11: t I0>>>
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 15/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
01 00 USER CONTROL
01 Remote control 1 Binary flag (5 bits) 0: Unlock trip cont.* Setting 0/ 31/1
1: Ack first alarm
2: Ack all alarms
3: TRIP
4: CLOSE
5 to 15: Reserved
03 00 MEASUREMENTS
01 I0 RMS Courier floating point Data
number
09 FREQUENCY Courier floating point Data Starting from V5.F
number
0E 00 CT RATIOS
01 CT Primary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1000 * Setting 1/3000/1
02 CT Secondary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/5/4
Protection Group n° 1
21 00 EARTH FAULT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 2102=1 Setting 0.01/1.0/0.005
number
04 Tempo Type I> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2102=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curves
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 16/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
05 Curve Type I> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2104=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
07 TMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2104=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
08 K I> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2104=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
09 Tempo I> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2104=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
0C-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I>> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 2111=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number
18 Tempo I>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2113=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
1C-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I>>> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n * 2121=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 17/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
23 Tempo I>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2121=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
60 00 AUTOMATISM
01 Trip Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: t I>>
2: t I>>>
6 to 15: reserved
02 Latched Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: Latch I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Latch I>>
2: Latch I>>>
6 to 15: reserved
03 Blocking 1 Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: Blocking t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Blocking t I>>
2: Blocking t I>>>
6 to 15: reserved
61 00 TS SETTINGS
01 Logical input allocation 1 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0/7/1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking
02 Logical input allocation 2 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0/7/1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 18/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
62 00 TC SETTINGS
01 GENERAL TRIP Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
02 I> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
03 tI> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
04 I>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
05 t I>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
06 I>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
07 t I>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
63 00 LEDS SETTINGS
01 Led 5 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>> *
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
02 Led 6 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>> *
5: t I>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
03 Led 7 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>> *
12 to 15: Reserved
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 19/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
04 Led 8 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
BF 00 COMM SYSTEM DATA
03 Setting Transfert Setting 0/1/1
04 Reset Demand Timers NOT IMPLEMENTED
05 Reset Event Report NOT IMPLEMENTED
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 20/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
10 Circuit Breaker Control Binary flag (3 bits) 0: No operation Data
1: Trip
2: Close
11 Software Reference ASCII Text (16 characters) Data
12-1F Unused, reserved
20 Logic Input Status Binary flag (3 bits) 0: log input 1 Data
1: log input 2
2: log input 3
21 Relay Output Status Binary flag (5 bits) 0: relay 1 (trip) Data
1: relay 2
2: relay 3
3: relay 4
4: watchdog relay
22 Alarm Binary flag (16 bits) 0: Ana output err Data
1: Comm err
2: Eeprom err data
3: Ct error
4: reserved
5: Eeprom err calib
6: reserved
7: reserved
8: reserved
9: Default settings
10 to 15: reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 22/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
23 Pseudo Logic Input Binary flag (12 bits) 0: I> Data
Status group 1 1: I>>
2: I>>>
3: I0>
4: I0>>
5: I0>>>
6: t I>
7: t I>>
8: t I>>>
9: t I0>
10: t I0>>
11: t I0>>>
01 00 USER CONTROL
01 Remote control 1 Binary flag (5 bits) 0: Unlock trip cont.* Setting 0/ 31/1
1: Ack first alarm
2: Ack all alarms
3: TRIP
4: CLOSE
5 to 15: Reserved
03 00 MEASUREMENTS
01 IA RMS Courier floating point Data
number
02 IB RMS Courier floating point Data
number
03 IC RMS Courier floating point Data
number
04 I0 RMS Courier floating point Data
number
09 FREQUENCY Courier floating point Data
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 23/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0D 00 GENERAL SETTING
01 Phase rotation sense Indexed string 0: Direct (A/B/C) Setting 0 (A/B/C)
1: Inverse (A/B/C) 1 (A/B/C)
0E 00 CT RATIOS
01 Phase CT Primary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1000 * Setting 1/3000/1
02 Phase CT Secondary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/5/4
03 Neutral CT Primary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1000 * Setting 1/3000/1
04 Neutral CT Secondary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/5/4
Protection Group n° 1
20 00 PHASE OVERCURRENT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 2002=1 Setting 0.1/25.0/0.1
number
04 Temporisation Type I> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2002=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
05 Curve type I> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2004=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 24/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
06 TMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2004=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
07 K I> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2004=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
08 Tempo I> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2004=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
0C-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 2011=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
13 Temporisation Type I>> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2011=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
14 Curve type I>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2013=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
15 TMS I>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2013=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
16 K I>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2013=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 25/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
17 Tempo I>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2013=0 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
1B-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I>>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 2021=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
23 Tempo I>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2021=1 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
21 00 EARTH FAULT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I0> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I0> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 2102=1 Setting 0.01/1.0/0.005
number
04 Tempo Type I0> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2102=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curves
05 Curve Type I0> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2104=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 26/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
06 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 2104=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
07 TMS I0> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2104=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
08 K I0> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2104=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
09 Tempo I0> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2104=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
0C-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I0>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I0>> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 2111=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number
13 Tempo Type I0>> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2111=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curves
14 Curve Type I0>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2113=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 27/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
15 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 2113=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0>> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
16 TMS I0>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2113=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
17 K I0>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2113=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
18 Tempo I0>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2113=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
1C-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I0>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I0>>> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n * 2121=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number
23 Tempo I0>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2121=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
60 00 AUTOMATISM
01 Trip Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: t I>>
2: t I>>>
3: t I0>
4: t I0>>
5: t I0>>>
6 to 15: reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 28/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
02 Latched Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: Latch I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Latch I>>
2: Latch I>>>
3: Latch I0>
4: Latch I0>>
5: Latch I0>>>
6 to 15: reserved
03 Blocking 1 Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0: Blocking t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Blocking t I>>
2: Blocking t I>>>
3: Blocking t I0>
4: Blocking t I0>>
5: Blocking t I0>>>
6 to 15: reserved
61 00 TS SETTINGS
01 Logical input allocation 1 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0/7/1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking
02 Logical input allocation 2 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0/7/1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 29/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
62 00 TC SETTINGS
01 GENERAL TRIP Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
02 I> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
03 tI> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
04 I>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
05 t I>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
06 I>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
07 t I>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
08 I0> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
09 t I0> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
0A I0>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
0B t I0>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
0C I0>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
0D t I0>>> Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
15 Reclosing Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
1D TC lock setting Binary (3 bits) 000 * Setting 0/7/1
bit 0 to 2 =1: TC Locked
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 30/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
63 00 LEDS SETTINGS
01 Led 5 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>> *
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
02 Led 6 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>> *
5: t I>>>
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 31/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 Led 7 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>> *
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
04 Led 8 Binary (16 bits) 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
6: I0> *
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12 to 15: Reserved
BF 00 COMM SYSTEM DATA
03 Setting Transfert
04 Reset Demand Timers NOT IMPLEMENTED
05 Reset Event Report NOT IMPLEMENTED
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 32/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
00 00 SYSTEM DATA
01 Language Ver>: Indexed String 0 Lang1 (French) Setting 0/3/1
1 Lang2 (English)*
2 Lang3 (German)
3 Lang4 (Spanish)
02 Password ASCII Password (4 bytes) AAAA Setting 32/127/1
03 Fnlinks:
NOT IMPLEMENTED
04 Description ASCII Text (6 bytes) “ P123 ”* Setting 32/127/1
05 Plant Reference ASCII Text (4 bytes) “ Pref ” Setting 32/127/1
06 Model Number ASCII Text (16 bytes) “ Model Number ” Data
07 Firmware Number ASCII Text (16 bytes) “ Firmware Number ” Data
08 Serial Number ASCII Text (16 bytes) “ Serial Number ” Data
09 Frequency Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) XXXX Hz Setting 50/60/10
0A Communication Level Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1 Data
0B Address Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/255/1
0C Plant Status Word:
NOT IMPLEMENTED
0D Control Status Word:
NOT IMPLEMENTED
0E Setting Group Unsigned Integer Data
0F Load shed Stage:
NOT IMPLEMENTED
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 33/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
10 Circuit Breaker Control Indexed String 0*: No operation Setting 0/2/1
1: Trip
2: Close
11 Software Reference ASCII Text (16 characters) Data
12-1F Unused, reserved
20 Logic Input Status Binary flag (5 bits) 0: log input 1 Data
1: log input 2
2: log input 3
3: log input 4
4: log input 5
21 Relay Output Status Binary flag (9 bits) 0: relay 1 (trip) Data
1: relay 2
2: relay 3
3: relay 4
4: watchdog relay
5: relay 5
6: relay 6
7: relay 7
8: relay 8
22 Alarm Binary flag (16 bits) 0: Ana output err Data
1: Comm err
2: Eeprom err data
3: Ct error
4: Clock error
5: Eeprom err calib
6: Ram error
7: Battery error
8: reserved
9: Default settings
10 to 15: reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 34/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
23 Pseudo Logic Input Binary flag (16 bits) 0: I> Data
Status group 1 1: I>>
2: I>>>
3: I0>
4: I0>>
5: I0>>>
6: t I>
7: t I>>
8: t I>>>
9: t I0>
10: t I0>>
11: t I0>>>
12: Thermal Alarm
13: Therm. Overload
14: t I<
15: reserved
24 Pseudo Logic Input Binary flag (16 bits) 0: Broken Conductor Data
Status group 2 1: t Aux 1
2: t Aux 2
3: Breaker Fail.
4: Iinv >
5: t Iinv>
6: Open operating time
7: Trip operation Nb
8: SA 2 n
9: SW Trip Circuit
10: Close operating time
11: Successful autoreclose
12: Locked autorecloser
13: Autorecloser conf. fail
14: Iinv>>
15: t Iinv>>
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 35/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
25 Pseudo Logic Input Binary flag (16 bits) 0: t Aux 3 Data
Status group 3 1: t Aux 4
2: t Reset I>
3: t Reset I>>
4: t Reset I0>
5: t Reset I0>>
6: t Reset I2>
7: t BF
8 à 15: reserved
01 00 USER CONTROL
01 Remote control 1 Binary flag (16 bits) 0: Unlock trip cont.* Setting 0/65535/1
1: Ack first alarm
2: Ack all alarms
3: TRIP
4: CLOSE
5: Setting Change
6: Th. State Reset
7: RMS aver&max Reset
8: Dist. Rec. Trig
9: Maintenance Start
10: Recloser timer Reset
11: Recloser Reset
12: Reserved
13: Reserved
14: Reserved
15: SRAM def . ack
02 Remote control 2 Binary flag (9 bits) 0: Relay 0: TRIP* Setting 0/511/1
1: Relay 1
2: Relay 2
3: Relay 3
4: Watchdog Relay
5: Relay 4
6: Relay 5
7: Relay 6
8: Relay 7
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 36/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 Remote control 3 Binary flag (6 bits) 0: Reset I0 Harmonic Setting 0/63/1
1: Reserved
2: Reserved
3: Maintenance stop
4: Reset rolling averages
5: Reset sub-period
average peaks.
02 00 VIEW RECORDS
01 Record number Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 5* Setting 1/5/1
02 Occur date Unsigned Integer (2 bytes)
03 Active set group Unsigned Integer (2 bytes)
04 Phase in fault ASCII Text
05 Fault Id ASCII Text
06 Magnitude Courier floating point
number
07 Ia magnitude Courier floating point
number
08 Ib magnitude Courier floating point
number
09 Ic magnitude Courier floating point
number
0A In magnitude Courier floating point
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 37/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 00 MEASUREMENTS
01 IA RMS Courier floating point Data
number
02 IB RMS Courier floating point Data
number
03 IC RMS Courier floating point Data
number
04 I0 RMS Courier floating point Data
number
05 Idirect Courier floating point Data
number
06 IINV Courier floating point Data
number
07 Ratio Idir / Iinv Courier floating point Data
number
08 THERMAL STATE (Rst) Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
(%)
09 FREQUENCY Courier floating point Data
number
0A RST RMS MAX &
AVERAGE
0B MAX RMS IA Courier floating point Data
number
0C MAX RMS IB Courier floating point Data
number
0D MAX RMS IC Courier floating point Data
number
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 38/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0E IA RMS AVERAGE Courier floating point Data
number
0F IB RMS AVERAGE Courier floating point Data
number
10 IC RMS AVERAGE Courier floating point Data
number
11 IN – Fn (Rst) Courier floating point Data
number
20 RST Sub-period
average Peaks
21 IA RMS Sub-period Courier floating point Data
average Peak number
22 IB RMS Sub-period Courier floating point Data
average Peak number
23 IC RMS Sub-period Courier floating point Data
average Peak number
24 RST Rolling Averages
25 IA RMS Rolling Average Courier floating point Data
number
26 IB RMS Rolling Average Courier floating point Data
number
27 IC RMS Rolling Average Courier floating point Data
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 39/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
04 00 RECLOSER
STATISTICS (Rst)
01 TOTAL CYCLE Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
NUMBER
02 CYCLE 1 NUMBER Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
03 CYCLE 2 NUMBER Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
04 CYCLE 3 NUMBER Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
05 CYCLE 4 NUMBER Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
06 DEFINITIVE TRIP Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
NUMBER
07 RECLOSE ORDER Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
NUMBER
05 00 PROCESS: in versions >
06 00 SW MONITORING
01 RST SAn Ix
02 SAn IA Courier floating point Data
number
03 SAn IB Courier floating point Data
number
04 SAn IC Courier floating point Data
number
05 SW operation nb (Rst) Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
06 SW operation time Courier floating point 0.0 s Data
number
07 SW Closing time Courier floating point Data
number
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 40/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
08 00 TIME:
01 Date/Time IEC870 Time & Date Data
02 Date Format (IEC/no) Indexed String 0: Private * Setting 0 (Private) / 1
1: IEC (IEC)
0D 00 GENERAL SETTING
01 Phase Rotation sense Indexed String 0: Direct (A/B/C) * Setting 0 (A/B/C) / 1
1: Inverse (A/C/B) (A/C/B)
0E 00 CT RATIOS
01 Phase CT Primary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1000 * Setting 1/50000/1
02 Phase CT Secondary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/5/4
03 Neutral CT Primary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1000 * Setting 1/50000/1
04 Neutral CT Secondary Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/5/4
0F 00 SETTING GROUPS
01 Setting group toggle Indexed String 0: Edge * Setting 0 (Edge) / 1
1: Level (Level)
02 Select setting group Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* 0F01=0 Setting 1/2
03 Group 1 visible Indexed String 0: YES * Setting 0 (YES) /
1: NO 1 (NO)
04 Group 2 visible Indexed String 0: YES Setting 0 (YES) /
1: NO * 1 (NO)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 41/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
Protection Group n° 1
20 00 PHASE
OVERCURRENT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 2002=1 Setting 0.1/25.0/0.1
number
04 Temporisation Type I> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2002=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
05 Curve type I> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2004=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
06 TMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2004=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
07 K I> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2004=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
08 Tempo I> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2004=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
09 Tempo reset type I> Indexed String 0: definite time 2004=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 2005>= 5 &
2005 <=9
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 42/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0A RTMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 2009 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
0B T RESET I> Courier floating point 0.04 2009 = 0 or Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number 2004 =0 or
2004 =2
or (2004=1 &
2005 < 5 &
2005 > 9)
0C-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 2011=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
13 Temporisation Type I>> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2011=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
14 Curve type I>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2013=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
15 TMS I>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2013=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 43/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
16 K I>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2013=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
17 Tempo I>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2013=0 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
18 Tempo reset type I>> Indexed String 0: definite time 2013=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 2014>= 5 &
2014 <=9
19 RTMS I>> Courier floating point 0.025 2018 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
1A T RESET I>> Courier floating point 0.04 2018 = 0 or Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number 2013 = 0 or
2013 =2
or (2013=1 &
2014 < 5 &
2014 > 9)
1B-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I>>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 2021=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
23 Tempo I>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2021=1 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
24 Sample I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 2021=1 Setting 0/1/1
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 44/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
21 00 EARTH FAULT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I0> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I0> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 2102=1 Setting 0.01/1.0/0.005
number or 0.002 I0n* if great or 0.1/25.0/0.01 if
sensivity normal sensitivity
or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
04 Tempo Type I0> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2102=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curves
05 Curve Type I0> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2104=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
06 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 2104=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
07 TMS I0> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2104=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
08 K I0> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2104=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 45/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
09 Tempo I0> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2104=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
0A Tempo reset Type I0> Indexed String 0: definite time 2104=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 2105>= 5 &
2105 <=9
0B RTMS I0> Courier floating point 0.025 210A = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
0C T RESET I0> Courier floating point 0.04 210A = 0 or Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number 2104 = 0 or
2104 =2
or 2104 =3
or (2104=1 &
2105 < 5 &
2105 > 9)
0D-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I0>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I0>> Courier floating point I0n* 2111=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number or 0.50 I0n* if normal or 0.50/40.0/0.01
sensitivity if normal
or 0.002 I0n* if great sensitivity
sensivity or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
13 Tempo Type I0>> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2111=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curves
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 46/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
14 Curve Type I0>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2113=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
15 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 2113=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0>> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
16 TMS I0>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 2113=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
17 K I0>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 2113=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
18 Tempo I0>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2113=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
19 Tempo reset Type I0>> Indexed String 0: definite time 2113=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 2114>= 5 &
2114 <=9
1A RTMS I0>> Courier floating point 0.025 2119 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
1B T RESET I0>> Courier floating point 0.04 2119 = 0 or Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number 2113 = 0 or
2113 =2
or 2113 =3
or (2113=1 &
2114 < 5 &
2114 > 9)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 47/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
1C-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I0>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I0>>> Courier floating point I0n* 2121=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number or 0.50 I0n* if normal or 0.50/40.0/0.01
sensitivity if normal
or 0.002 I0n* if great sensitivity
sensivity or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
23 Tempo I0>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2121=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
24 Sample I0>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 2121=1 Setting 0/1/1
22 00 THERMAL OVERLOAD
01 Ith> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold Ith> Courier floating point 0.10 Ith* 2201=1 Setting 0.01/3.2/0.01
number
03 K Ith> Courier floating point 1.05 * 2201=1 Setting 1.0/1.50/0.01 In
number
04 θ TRIP Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 100 % * 2201=1 Setting 50 / 200/ 1 %
05 θ ALARM ? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 2201=1 Setting 0/1/1
06 θ ALARM Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 90 % * 2205 =1 Setting 50 / 200/ 1 %
07 Thermal constant Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* 2201=1 Setting 1/ 200 / 1 mn
23 00 MIN I<
01 I< Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold I< Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 20 %In * 2301=1 Setting 2 / 100 / 1 %In
03 Tempo I < Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2301=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 48/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
24 00 NEGATIVE CURRENT
01 Iinv> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold Iinv> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 2401 = 1 Setting 0.1/40.0/0.01 In
number
03 Temporisation Type Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 2401 = 1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
04 Curve type Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 2403 = 1 Setting 0/9/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
05 TMS Courier floating point 0.025 * 2403=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
06 K (RI) Courier floating point 0.1 * 2403=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
07 Tempo Iinv> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2403=0 Setting 0 /150.0/1.0
number
08 Reset tempo type Indexed String 0: definite time 2403=1 & Setting 0/1/1
1: inverse time 2404>= 5 &
2404 <=9
09 RTMS Courier floating point 0.025 * 2408 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 49/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0A T RESET Courier floating point 0.04 * 2408 = 0 Setting 0.04/100/0.01
number or 2403 =2
or (2403=1 &
2404 < 5 &
2404 > 9)
10 Iinv>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
11 Threshold Iinv>> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 2410 = 1 Setting 0.1/40.0/0.01 In
number
12 Tempo Iinv>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2410 = 1 Setting 0 /150.0/1.0
number
25 00 AUTORECLOSER
01 Autorecloser Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 State circuit breaker Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 2501 = 1 Setting 0/1/1
03 Control window Courier floating point 0.01 s * 2502 = 1 Setting 0.01 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
04 External blocking Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 2501 = 1 Setting 0/1/1
07 Temporisation cycle 1 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 300.00 /
number 0.01 s
08 Temporisation cycle 2 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 300.00 /
number 0.01 s
09 Temporisation cycle 3 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0A Temporisation cycle 4 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0B Reclaim TIME Courier floating point 0.02 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.02 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0C Inhibition time Courier floating point 0.02 s * 2501 = 1 Setting 0.02 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 50/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0D Number of short circuit Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 2501 = 1 Setting 0/4/1
cycle
0E Number of earth fault Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 2501 = 1 Setting 0/4/1
cycle
0F Cycles tI> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
10 Cycles tI>> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
11 Cycles tI>>> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
12 Cycles tI0> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
13 Cycles tI0>> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
14 Cycles tI0>>> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
15 Cycles tAux1> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
16 Cycles tAux2> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 2501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 51/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
Protection Group n° 2
40 00 PHASE
OVERCURRENT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 4002=1 Setting 0.1/25.0/0.1
number
04 Tempo Type I> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 4002=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
05 Curve Type I> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 4004=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
06 TMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 * 4004=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
07 K I> Courier floating point 0.1 * 4004=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
08 Tempo I> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4004=0 Setting 0.01/150.0/1.0
number
09 Reset tempo type I> Indexed String 0: definite time 4004=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 4005>= 5 &
4005 <=9
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 52/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0A RTMS I> Courier floating point 0.025 4009 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
0B T RESET I> Courier floating point 0.04 4009 = 0 Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number or 4004 =0
or 4004 =2
or (4004=1 &
4005 < 5 &
4005 > 9)
0C-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 4011=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
13 Tempo Type I>> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 4011=1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
14 Curve Type I>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 4013=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
15 TMS I>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 4013=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
16 K I>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 4013=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 53/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
17 Tempo I>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4013=0 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
18 Reset tempo type I>> Indexed String 0: definite time 4013=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 4014>= 5 &
4014 <=9
19 RTMS I>> Courier floating point 0.025 4018 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
1A T RESET I>> Courier floating point 0.04 4018 = 0 Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number or 4013 =0
or 4013 =2
or (4013=1 &
4014 < 5 &
4014 > 9)
1B-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I>>> Courier floating point 0.50 In * 4021=1 Setting 0.5/40.0/0.05
number
23 Tempo I>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4021=1 Setting 0 /150/0.01
number
24 Sample I>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 4021=1 Setting 0/1/1
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 54/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
41 00 EARTH FAULT
01 Stage 1 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
02 Max I0> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Threshold I0> Courier floating point 0.01 I0n* 4102=1 Setting 0.01/1.0/0.005
number or 0.002 I0n* if great or 0.1/25.0/0.01if
sensivity normal sensitivity
or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
04 Temporisation Type I0> Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 4102=1 Setting 0/3/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curve
05 Curve type I0> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 4104=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
06 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 4104=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
07 TMS I0> Courier floating point 0.025 * 4104=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
08 K I0> Courier floating point 0.1 * 4104=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 55/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
09 Tempo I0> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4104=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
0A Tempo reset Type I0> Indexed String 0: definite time 4104=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 4105>= 5 &
4105 <=9
0B RTMS I0> Courier floating point 0.025 4109 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
0C T RESET I0> Courier floating point 0.04 4109 = 0 Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number or 4104 =0
or 4104 =2
or 4104 =3
or (4104=1 &
4105 < 5 &
4105 > 9)
0D-0F Reserved
10 Stage 2 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
11 Max I0>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
12 Threshold I0>> Courier floating point I0n* 4111=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number or 0.50 I0n* if normal or 0.50/40.0/0.01
sensitivity if normal
or 0.002 I0n* if great sensitivity
sensivity or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
13 Temporisation Type Indexed String 0 0: definite time * 4111=1 Setting 0/3/1
I0>> 1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
3 3: Laborelec curve
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 56/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
14 Curve type I0>> Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 4113=1 Setting 0/10/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
10 RC (CEI)
15 Curve Type 2 Indexed String 0 Curve type 1 * 4113=3 Setting 0/2/1
(Laborelec) I0>> 1 Curve type 2
2 Curve type 3
16 TMS I0>> Courier floating point 0.025 * 4113=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
17 K I0>> Courier floating point 0.1 * 4113=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
18 Tempo I0>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4113=0 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
19 Tempo reset Type I0>> Indexed String 0: definite time 4113=1 & Setting 0/1
1: inverse time 4114 >= 5 &
4114 <=9
1A RTMS I0>> Courier floating point 0.025 4119 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
1B T RESET I0>> Courier floating point 0.04 4119 = 0 Setting 0/600.0/0.01
number or 4113 =0
or 4113 =2
or 4113 =3
or (4113=1 &
4114 < 5 &
4114 > 9)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 57/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
1C-1F Reserved
20 Stage 3 Overcurrent (Sub Heading)
21 Max I0>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
22 Threshold I0>>> Courier floating point I0n* 4121=1 Setting 0.01/8.0/0.005
number or 0.50 I0n* if normal or 0.50/40.0/0.01
sensitivity if normal
or 0.002 I0n* if great sensitivity
sensivity or 0.002/1.0/0.001
if great sensivity
23 Tempo I0>>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4121=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
24 Sample I0>>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 4121=1 Setting 0/1/1
42 00 THERMAL OVERLOAD
01 Ith> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold Ith> Courier floating point 0.10 Ith* 4201=1 Setting 0.01/3.2/0.01
number
03 K Ith> Courier floating point 1.05 * 4201=1 Setting 1.0/1.50/0.01 In
number
04 θ TRIP Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 100 % * 4201=1 Setting 50 / 200/ 1 %
05 θ ALARM ? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled 4201=1 Setting 0/1/1
06 θ ALARM Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 90 % * 4205 =1 Setting 50 / 200/ 1 %
07 Thermal constant Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* 4201=1 Setting 1/ 200 / 1 mn
43 00 MIN I<
01 I< Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold I< Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 20 %In * 4301=1 Setting 2 / 100 / 1 %In
03 Tempo I < Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4301=1 Setting 0 /150.0/0.01
number
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 58/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
44 00 NEGATIVE CURRENT
01 Iinv> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Threshold Iinv> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 4401 = 1 Setting 0.1/40.0/0.01 In
number
03 Temporisation type 0 0: definite time * 4401 = 1 Setting 0/2/1
1 1: inverse time
2 2: RI curve
04 Curve Type Indexed String 0 STI (CEI) * 4401 = 1 Setting 0/9/1
1 SI (CEI)
2 VI (CEI)
3 EI (CEI)
4 LTI (CEI)
5 STI (CO2)
6 MI (ANSI)
7 LTI (CO8)
8 VI (ANSI)
9 EI (ANSI)
05 TMS Courier floating point 0.025 * 4403=1 Setting 0.025/1.5/0.025
number
06 K (RI) Courier floating point 0.1 * 4403=2 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.005
number
07 Tempo Iinv> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4403=0 Setting 0 /150.0/1.0
number
08 Temporisation reset type Indexed String 0: definite time 4403=1 & Setting 0/1/1
1: inverse time 4404>= 5 &
4404 <=9
09 RTMS Courier floating point 0.025 * 4408 = 1 Setting 0.025/3.2/0.025
number
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 59/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0A T RESET Courier floating point 0.04 * 4408 = 0 or Setting 0.04/100/0.01
number 4403 =2 or
(4403=1 &
4404 < 5 &
4404 > 9)
10 Iinv>> Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
11 Threshold Iinv>> Courier floating point 0.1 In * 4410 = 1 Setting 0.1/40.0/0.01 In
number
12 Tempo Iinv>> Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4410 = 1 Setting 0 /150.0/1.0
number
45 00 AUTORECLOSER
01 Autorecloser Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 State circuit breaker Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 4501 = 1 Setting 0/1/1
03 Control window Courier floating point 0.01 s * 4502 = 1 Setting 0.01 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
04 External blocking Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 4501 = 1 Setting 0/1/1
07 Temporisation cycle 1 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 300.00 /
number 0.01 s
08 Temporisation cycle 2 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 300.00 /
number 0.01 s
09 Temporisation cycle 3 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0A Temporisation cycle 4 Courier floating point 0.05 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.05 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0B Reclaim TIME Courier floating point 0.02 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.02 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
0C Inhibition time Courier floating point 0.02 s * 4501 = 1 Setting 0.02 / 600.00 /
number 0.01 s
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 60/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0D Number of short circuit Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 4501 = 1 Setting 0/4/1
cycle
0E Number of earth fault Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 4501 = 1 Setting 0/4/1
cycle
0F Cycles tI> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
10 Cycles tI>> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
11 Cycles tI>>> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
12 Cycles tI0> configuration Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
bit group
13 Cycles tI0>> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
14 Cycles tI0>>> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
15 Cycles tAux1> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
16 Cycles tAux2> Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0x1111 * 4501 = 1 Setting 0/2/1 on each 4
configuration bit group
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 61/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
60 00 AUTOMATISM
01 Trip Configuration Binary (15 bits) 1* 0: t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: t I>>
2: t I>>>
3: t I0>
4: t I0>>
5: t I0>>>
6: t I<
7: t Therm
8: Broken Conductor
9: t Aux1
10: t Aux2
11: t I2>
12: t I2>>
13: t Aux3
14: t Aux4
15: reserved
02 Latch Configuration Binary (15 bits) 0* 0: Latch I> Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Latch I>>
2: Latch I>>>
3: Latch I0>
4: Latch I0>>
5: Latch I0>>>
6: Latch I<
7: Latch Therm. Ov.
8: Latch Broken Conductor
9: Latch Aux1
10: Latch Aux2
11: Latch I2>
12: Latch I2>>
13: Latch Aux3
14: Latch Aux
15: reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 62/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 Blocking 1 Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0* 0: Blocking t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Blocking t I>>
2: Blocking t I>>>
3: Blocking t I0>
4: Blocking t I0>>
5: Blocking t I0>>>
6: Blocking t I<
7: Blocking t Therm
8: Blocking Broken
Conductor
9: Blocking t Aux1
10: Blocking t Aux2
11: Blocking t I2>
12: Blocking t I2>>
13: Blocking t Aux3
14: Blocking t Aux4
15: reserved
04 Blocking 2 Configuration Binary (16 bits) 0* 0: Blocking t I> * Setting 0 / 65535 / 1
1: Blocking t I>>
2: Blocking t I>>>
3: Blocking t I0>
4: Blocking t I0>>
5: Blocking t I0>>>
6: Blocking t I<
7: Blocking t Therm
8: Blocking Broken
Conductor
9: Blocking t Aux1
10: Blocking t Aux2
11: Blocking t I2>
12: Blocking t I2>>
13: Blocking t Aux3
14: Blocking t Aux4
15: reserved
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 63/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
05 Broken conductor Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
detection
06 Tempo tBC Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 6005 = 1 Setting 0 / 144.0 / 0.01 s
07 Threshold mod Courier floating point 20 % * 6005 = 1 Setting 20 / 100 / 1 %
iinv/idirect in % number
08 Cold load start Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
09 Threshold of cold load Binary (8 bits) 0* 6008 = 1 Setting 0 / 255 / 1
start
0A % of cold load start Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 50 % * 6008 = 1 Setting 100 / 500 / 1
0B Cold load start Tempo Courier floating point 1.0 s * 6008 = 1 Setting 0.1 / 3600.0 / 0.1
number s
0C Breaker failure Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
0D I< Threshold for Breaker Courier floating point 10 % * 600C = 1 Setting 2 / 100/ 1 %
failure number
0E Tempo tBF Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0.1 s * 600C = 1 Setting 0.03 / 10.0 / 0.01
s
0F Phase instant blocking Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 600C = 1 Setting 0 / 1/ 1
10 Earth instant blocking Binary (1 bit) Disabled * / Enabled 600C = 1 Setting 0 / 1/ 1
11 Logic selectivity 1 Binary (4 bits) Setting 0 / 15/ 1
12 Tempo selectivity1 Courier floating point 6011 = 1 Setting 0 / 150.0 / 0.01 s
number
13 Logic selectivity 2 Binary (4 bits) Setting 0 / 15 / 1
14 Tempo selectivity 2 Courier floating point 6013 = 1 Setting 0 / 150.0 / 0.01 s
number
15 Trip Configuration 2/2 Binary (2 bits) 0* 0: Trip SOTF Setting 0/3/1
1: Control TRIP
16 Latch Configuration 2/2 Binary (2 bits) 0* 0: Latch SOTF Setting 0/3/1
1: Reserved
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 64/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
61 00 TS SETTINGS
01 Logical input allocation 1 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0 / 23 / 1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking 1
8 8: Logic blocking 2
9 9: Disturbance start
10 10: Cold load start
11 11: Log Selectivity 1
12 12: Log Selectivity 2
13 13: Change of group
14 14: Recloser locked
15 15: Thermal reset
16 16: Trip circuit supervision
17 17: external CB failure
18 18: Leds reset
19 19: Maintenance mode
20 20: External input 3
21 21: External input 4
22 22: Manual Close
23 23: Local Mode
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 65/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
02 Logical input allocation 2 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0 / 23 / 1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking 1
8 8: Logic blocking 2
9 9: Disturbance start
10 10: Cold load start
11 11: Log Selectivity 1
12 12: Log Selectivity 2
13 13: Change of group
14 14: Recloser locked
15 15: Thermal reset
16 16: Trip circuit supervision
17 17: external CB failure
18 18: Leds reset
19 19: Maintenance mode
20 20: External input 3
21 21: External input 4
22 22: Manual Close
23 23: Local Mode
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 66/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 Logical input allocation 3 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0 / 23 / 1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking 1
8 8: Logic blocking 2
9 9: Disturbance start
10 10: Cold load start
11 11: Log Selectivity 1
12 12: Log Selectivity 2
13 13: Change of group
14 14: Recloser locked
15 15: Thermal reset
16 16: Trip circuit supervision
17 17: external CB failure
18 18: Leds reset
19 19: Maintenance mode
20 20: External input 3
21 21: External input 4
22 22: Manual Close
23 23: Local Mode
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 67/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
04 Logical input allocation 4 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0 / 23 / 1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking 1
8 8: Logic blocking 2
9 9: Disturbance start
10 10: Cold load start
11 11: Log Selectivity 1
12 12: Log Selectivity 2
13 13: Change of group
14 14: Recloser locked
15 15: Thermal reset
16 16: Trip circuit supervision
17 17: external CB failure
18 18: Leds reset
19 19: Maintenance mode
20 20: External input 3
21 21: External input 4
22 22: Manual Close
23 23: Local Mode
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 68/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
05 Logical input allocation 5 Indexed String 0 0: nothing * Setting 0 / 23 / 1
1 1: delatch
2 2: 52 a
3 3: 52 b
4 4: CB failure
5 5: External input 1
6 6: External input 2
7 7: Logic blocking 1
8 8: Logic blocking 2
9 9: Disturbance start
10 10: Cold load start
11 11: Log Selectivity 1
12 12: Log Selectivity 2
13 13: Change of group
14 14: Recloser locked
15 15: Thermal reset
16 16: Trip circuit supervision
17 17: external CB failure
18 18: Leds reset
19 19: Maintenance mode
20 20: External input 3
21 21: External input 4
22 22: Manual Close
23 23: Local Mode
06 Timer aux 1 Courier floating point number 0* Setting 0 / 200.0 / 0.01
07 Timer aux 2 Courier floating point number 0* Setting 0 / 200.0 / 0.01
08 TS setting (Edge type) Binary (5 bits) Bit 0 to 4 = 0: Rising edge Setting 0 / 31 / 1
Bit 0 to 4 = 1: Falling edge
09 TS voltage Indexed String 0 * = DC Setting 0/1/1
1 = AC
0A Timer aux 3 Courier floating point number 0* Setting 0 / 200.0 / 0.01
0B Timer aux 4 Courier floating point number 0* Setting 0 / 200.0 / 0.01
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 69/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
62 00 TC SETTINGS
01 GENERAL TRIP Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
02 I> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
03 tI> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
04 I>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
05 t I>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
06 I>>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
07 t I>>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
08 I0> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
09 t I0> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0A I0>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0B t I0>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0C I0>>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0D t I0>>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0E Broken conductor Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
0F Breaker failure Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
10 t I< Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
11 t Iinv> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
12 t Iinv>> Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
13 Thermal alarm Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
14 Thermal trip Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
15 Reclosing Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
16 tAux 1 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
17 tAux 2 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 70/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
18 Breaker alarm Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
19 Trip circuit alarm Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
1A Autoreclose in progress Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
1B Definitive trip Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
1C TC Active Setting Group Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
bit 0 to 6 =0: Group 1
bit 0 to 6 =1: Group 2
1D TC lock setting Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
bit 0 to 6 =1: TC Locked
1E tAux 3 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
1F tAux 4 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
20 tCOMM1 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
21 tCOMM2 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
22 tCOMM3 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
23 tCOMM4 Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
24 SOTF Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
25 CONTROL TRIP Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
26 CONTROL CLOSE Binary (7 bits) 0000000 * Setting 0/127/1
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 71/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
63 00 LEDS SETTINGS
01 Led 5 Binary (16 bits) 4* 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>> *
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12: Thermal Overload
13: t I2>
14: Broken Conductor
15: Breaker Failure
02 Led 6 Binary (16 bits) 16 * 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>> *
5: t I>>>
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12: Thermal Overload
13: t I2>
14: Broken Conductor
15: Breaker Failure
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 72/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
03 Led 7 Binary (16 bits) 32 * 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>> *
6: I0>
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12: Thermal Overload
13: t I2>
14: Broken Conductor
15: Breaker Failure
04 Led 8 Binary (16 bits) 64 * 0: I> Setting 0/65535/1
1: t I>
2: I>>
3: t I>>
4: I>>>
5: t I>>>
6: I0> *
7: t I0>
8: I0>>
9: t I0>>
10: I0>>>
11: t I0>>>
12: Thermal Overload
13: t I2>
14: Broken Conductor
15: Breaker Failure
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 73/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
05 Led PF5 Binary (9 bits) 0* 0: Input 1 Setting 0/2047/1
1: Input 2
2: Input 3
3: Input 4
4: Input 5
5: Locked Autorecloser
6:Autorecloser in progress
7: t Aux1
8: t Aux2
9: t I2>>
10: SOTF
06 Led PF6 Binary (9 bits) 0* 0: Input 1 Setting 0/2047/1
1: Input 2
2: Input 3
3: Input 4
4: Input 5
5: Locked Autorecloser
6:Autorecloser in progress
7: t Aux1
8: t Aux2
9: t I2>>
10: SOTF
07 Led PF7 Binary (9 bits) 0* 0: Input 1 Setting 0/2047/1
1: Input 2
2: Input 3
3: Input 4
4: Input 5
5: Locked Autorecloser
6:Autorecloser in progress
7: t Aux1
8: t Aux2
9: t I2>>
10: SOTF
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 74/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
08 Led PF8 Binary (9 bits) 0* 0: Input 1 Setting 0/2047/1
1: Input 2
2: Input 3
3: Input 4
4: Input 5
5: Locked Autorecloser
6:Autorecloser in progress
7: t Aux1
8: t Aux2
9: t I2>>
10: SOTF
64 00 ALARMS
01 Instant. alarm self-reset Binary (1 bits) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Reset leds on Fault Binary (1 bits) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
03 Battery alarm Binary (1 bits) Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
69 00 SW SUPERVISION
01 Trip circuit supervision ? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 Trip circuit time ? Courier floating point 0.1 s * 6901 = 1 Setting 0.1/10.0/0.05 s
number
03 SW Operating time? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
04 SW Operating time Courier floating point 0.05 s* 6903 = 1 Setting 0.05/1.0/0.05 s
number
05 SW Operating number? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
06 SW Closing time ? Courier floating point 0.05 s* 6905 = 1 Setting 0.05/1.0/0.05 s
number
07 SW Closing time Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
08 SW Operating number Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 0* 6907 = 1 Setting 0/50000/1
09 SA2n? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 75/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
0A SA2n Courier floating point 0 exp+06 A² * 6909 = 1 Setting 0/4000/1
number (*exp+06)
0B n Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1* Setting 1/2/1
0C TRIP t Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
0D CLOSE t Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
6A 00 COMM ORDER LATCH
TIMES
01 t COMM1 Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
02 t COMM2 Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
03 t COMM3 Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
04 t COMM4 Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0.1/5.0/0.05 s
number
6B 00 SWITCH ON TO FAULT
01 SOTF function ? Binary (1 bit) 0 Disabled * / Enabled Setting 0/1/1
02 tManual close Courier floating point 0.1 s* Setting 0/0.50/0.01 s
number
03 Start I>> / I>>> Binary (2 bit) 0 0*: Start I>> Setting 0/3/1
1 1: Start I>>>
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 76/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
70 00 RECORDER CONTROL VERSION P122 & P123
01 Start/Trigger recorder Indexed String 0 Stopped Setting 1/2/1
1 Trigerred
2 Running *
02 Recorder Source Indexed String 0 Samples * Data
20 Pretemps Courier floating point 0.1 secondes Setting 0.1/3.0/0.1
number
21 Postemps Courier floating point 0.1 secondes Setting 0.1/3.0/0.1
number
22 Trigger Indexed String 0 On Inst* / On Trig Setting 0/1/1
30 Measurement period Indexed String 0 5* / 10 / 15 / 30 / 60 min Setting 0/4/1
40 Rolling Demands
41 Rolling sub-period Courier floating point 1 min* Setting 1/60/1
number
42 Rolling sub-period Courier floating point 1* Setting 1/24/1
number number
80 00 DISTURBANCE REC
01 Record Number Unsigned integer (1 byte) 0* Setting 0/5/1 (selon
contexte)
02 Trigger Time IEC870 Time & Date dd/mm/yy hh:mm Data
03 Available Channel Bit Binary Flag 11111 Data
Mask Indexed String 0 “ Ia ”
1 “ Ib ”
2 “ Ic ”
3 “ I0 ”
4 “ Inputs/Outputs ”
04 Channel Types Binary Flag 0: digital, 1: 01111 Data
analogue
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
Courier Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 77/168
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
05 Channel Offsets Repeated group of Courier Upload Offsets Data
numbers
06 Scaling Factors Repeated group of Courier Upload Scal. Factors Data
numbers
07-0F NOT IMPLEMENTED -
reserved
10 Record Length Integer (2 bytes) Data
11 Trigger position Integer (2 bytes) Data
12 Time Base Courier floating point Data
number
13 NOT IMPLEMENTED -
reserved
14 Upload Timer Repeated group of Integers Data
15-1F NOT IMPLEMENTED -
reserved
20 Upload Channel 0 Repeated group of Integers Data
21 Upload Channel 1 Repeated group of Integers Data
22 Upload Channel 2 Repeated group of Integers Data
23 Upload Channel 3 Repeated group of Integers Data
24 Upload Channel Repeated group of Data
Inputs/Outputs Integer/Bin. flags
90 00 AUTOMAT. FLT
01 Record number Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Setting
(automatic)
02 Occur fault date Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) Data
03 Active set group Unsigned Integer (2 bytes) 1 Data
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
Courier Database
Page 78/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Values
Col Row Menu Text Data Type Ind Depend Cell Type Min/Max/Step
(*: default)
04 Phase in fault ASCII Text (10 bytes) “ PHASE A ” Data
05 Fault Id ASCII Text (18 bytes) “ I >> ” Data
06 Magnitude Courier floating point 12.34 A Data
number
07 Ia Magnitude Courier floating point 12.34 A Data
number
08 Ib Magnitude Courier floating point 12.34 A Data
number
09 Ic Magnitude Courier floating point 12.34 A Data
number
0A In Magnitude Courier floating point 12.34 A Data
number
BF 00 COMM SYSTEM DATA
01 Dist Record Cntrl Ref Menu Cell (2) 0x7000 Data
02 Dist Record Extract Ref Menu Cell (2) 0x8000 Data
03 Setting Transfert
04 Reset Demand Timers NOT IMPLEMENTED
05 Reset Event Report NOT IMPLEMENTED
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
IEC 60870-5-103
MiCOM P120 - P121 - P122- P123
VERSION V5
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
IEC 60870-5-103
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 1/168
CONTENTS
1. IEC60870-5-103 INTERFACE 3
1.1 Physical connection and link layer 3
1.2 Initialisation 3
1.3 Time synchronisation (P122 & P123 only) 3
1.4 Spontaneous events (P122 & P123 only) 4
1.5 General interrogation 4
1.6 Cyclic measurements 4
1.7 Commands 4
1.8 Disturbance records (P122 & P123 only) 4
1.9 Blocking of monitor direction 4
2. APPENDIX 1 5
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
IEC 60870-5-103
Page 2/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
BLANK PAGE
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
IEC 60870-5-103
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 3/168
1. IEC60870-5-103 INTERFACE
The IEC60870-5-103 interface is a master/slave interface with the relay as the slave device.
This protocol is based on the VDEW communication protocol. The relay conforms to
compatibility level 2, compatibility level 3 is not supported.
The following IEC60870-5-103 facilities are supported by this interface:
• Initialisation (Reset)
• Time Synchronisation
• General Interrogation
• Cyclic Measurements
• General Commands
1.1 Physical connection and link layer
Connection is available for IEC60870-5-103 through the rear RS485 port. It is possible to
select both the relay address and baud rate using the front panel interface. Following a
change, a reset command is required to re-establish communications.
The parameters of the communication are the following:
• Even Parity
• 8 Data bits
• 1 stop bit
• Common Address
• Function Type
• Information number
APPENDIX 1 contains a complete listing of all events produced by the relay. The common
address is used to differentiate in circumstances where the relay produces more events of a
certain type than can be passed using the standardised messages. For example if the relay
produces starts and trips for three stages of overcurrent only two stages can be passed
using the standardised messages.
Using the different common address for two of the overcurrent stages allows each stage to
be indicated. The table in APPENDIX 1 shows the common address as an offset value. The
common address offset will be added to the station address in order to pass these events.
1.5 General interrogation
The GI request can be used to read the status of the relay, the function numbers, information
numbers and common address offsets that will be returned during the GI cycle are indicated
in APPENDIX 1.
1.6 Cyclic measurements
The relay will produce measured values using ASDU 9 on a cyclical basis, this can be read
from the relay using a Class 2 poll (note ADSU 3 is not used).
It should be noted that the measurands transmitted by the relay are sent as a proportion of
either 1.2 or 2.4 times the rated value of the analogue value. The selection of either 1.2 or
2.4 for a particular value is indicated in APPENDIX 1.
1.7 Commands
A list of the supported commands is contained in APPENDIX 1. The relay will respond to
other commands with an ASDU 1, with a cause of transmission (COT) of negative
acknowledgement of a command.
1.8 Disturbance records (P122 & P123 only)
The disturbance records stored by the relay cannot be extracted using the mechanism
defined in the IEC60870-5-103 standard. The relay maintains compatibility with the VDEW
control system by transmitting an ASDU 23 with no disturbance records at the start of every
GI cycle.
1.9 Blocking of monitor direction
The relay does not support a facility to block messages in the Monitor direction.IEC 60870-5-
103 DATABASES
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
IEC 60870-5-103
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 5/168
2. APPENDIX 1
Spontaneous messages managed by MiCOM P12x
These messages includes a sub-assembly of events which are generated on the relay,
because some generated events are not registered in VDEW. They are the most priority
messages.
An event is always generated on the rising edge of the information.
Some events can be generated on the rising or lowering edge.
In the list below, events only generated on rising edge will be tagged with a ‘*’.
Two types of ASDU can be generated for events: ASDU 1 (time-tagged message) or ASDU
2 (time-tagged message with relative time).
The following list of processed events is the list with the private messages option active,
for all Overcurrent protection functions, with the associated FUNCTION Type,
INFORMATION NUMBER, ASDU TYPE, CAUSE OF TRANSMISSION and COMMON
ADDRESS OF ASDU (The corresponding numbers with private messages option inactive
are given just below).
FUN <160>: Function type in Public range for Overcurrent Protections (compatible).
FUN <168>: Function type in Private range (Reserved for Overcurrent Protections).
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
IEC 60870-5-103
Page 6/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
− Local parameter Setting active: FUN<160>;INF <22>; TYP <1>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P120 to P123
− Setting Group number 1 active: FUN<160>;INF <23>; TYP <1>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P122-P123
− Setting Group number 2 active: FUN<160>;INF <24>; TYP <1>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P122-P123
− Start / pick-up I>: FUN<168>;INF <9>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P121 to P123
− Start / pick-up I>>: FUN<168>;INF <10>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P121 to P123
− Start / pick-up I>>>: FUN<168>;INF <11>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P121 to P123
− Start / pick-up IN>: FUN<168>;INF <12>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P120 to P123
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
IEC 60870-5-103
Page 8/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
− Start / pick-up IN>>: FUN<168>;INF <13>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P120 to P123
− Start / pick-up IN>>>: FUN<168>;INF <14>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P120 to P123
− General Start / pick-up: FUN<160>;INF <84>; TYP <2>; COT<1>,<ADDR>↑↓ P120 to P123
NOTE: The double arrow ↑↓ means that the event generated on event occurrence and another event is generated on event disappearing.
System state
List of data contained in General Interrogation
It is given in the answer to the General Interrogation (GI).
Relay state information are Class 1 data, they are systematically sent to the master station, during a General Interrogation.
The list of processed data, following a General Interrogation, is given below: it is a sub-assembly of the spontaneous message list, so like spontaneous
messages, these data are generated on rising and lowering edge.
Status indications (monitor direction): Availability
− Local parameter Setting active: FUN<160>;INF <22>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P120 to P123
− Setting Group number 1 active: FUN<160>;INF <23>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P122-P123
− Setting Group number 2 active: FUN<160>;INF <24>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P122-P123
− General Start / pick-up: FUN<160>;INF <84>; TYP <2>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P120 to P123
Auto-recloser Indications in monitor direction: Availability
− CB in O/O (« closed ») position: FUN<168>;INF <33>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P121 to P123
with private option inactive: FUN<160>;INF <140>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR>
− CB in F/O (« open ») position: FUN<168>;INF <34>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR> P121 to P123
with private option inactive: FUN<160>;INF <141>; TYP <1>; COT<9>,<ADDR>
Processed Commands
System Commands: Availability
If a data has just changed before extracted by the GI, the new state is sent to the master station.
When an event is generated during the GI cycle, the event is sent in priority, and the GI cycle is temporarily interrupted. The end of the GI consists in
sending an ASDU 8 to the master station.
If, during a General Interrogation cycle, another GI Initialization command is received, the precedent answer is stopped, and the new GI cycle started.
General Commands (ASDU 20) (Control direction): Availability
− LEDs Reset: This command acknowledge all alarms on Front Panel on MiCOM P12x products:
FUN<160>;INF<19>, TYP<20>, COT <20>,<ADDR> P120 to P123
If a state change is the consequence of the command, it must be sent in a ASDU 1 with COT 12 (remote operation).
If the relay receive another command message from the master station before sending the acknowledge message, it will be discarded.
Commands which are not processed by the relay are rejected with a negative acknowledge message.
Relay re initialization
In case of relay re initialization, the relay send to the master station: Availability
− A message indicating relay start (FUN<160>;INF <5>; TYP <5> COT <6>) P120 to P123
− or a message indicating Reset CU (FUN<160>;INF <5>; TYP <5> COT <4>) P120 to P123
− or a message indicating Reset FCB (FUN<160>;INF <5>; TYP <5> COT <3>) P120 to P123
Each identification message of the relay (ASDU 5) contains the manufacturer name in 8 ASCII characters et 4 free characters containing: « P122 » or
« P123 ».
Cyclic Messages (ASDU9 and ASDU 77)
Only measurands can be stored in these messages.
The measurands values are stored in lower levels of communication, before polling by master station.
Several of the fields in the ASDU 9 (FUN<160>,INF <148>) are unused in the P122/P123 relay (Voltage and Power values), so they are set to 0: Only
RMS Ia, Ib, Ic values and frequency are stored (with a rate such as: 2,4 * nominal value = 4096).
The second ASDU is ASDU3.4 (FUN<160>,INF<147>), which contains in first position In earth current value in rated format (with a rate such as: 2,4 *
nominal value = 4096). Vn value does not exist, so the second position value in ASDU3.4 is set to « unused ».
Another ASDU, ASDU 77 (FUN<168>,INF <209>), which is a private ASDU, contains 4 other measurands: Iinverse and Idirect values, Thermal state (in
%), in «short floating-point » format (IEEE 32 bits floating-point format). These values are not rated.
with private option inactive: FUN<160>,INF <149>
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
IEC 60870-5-103
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 15/168
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CONTENTS
1. INTRODUCTION 3
1.1 Purpose of this document 3
1.2 DNP V3.00 device Profile 3
1.3 Implementation Table 6
1.4 Point List 8
1.4.1 Binary Input Points 8
1.4.2 Binary Output Status Points and Control Relay Output Blocks 11
1.4.3 Counters 12
1.4.4 Analog Inputs 13
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
DNP 3.0 Database
Page 2/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
BLANK PAGE
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
DNP 3.0 Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 3/168
1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Purpose of this document
The purpose of this document is to describe the specific implementation of the Distributed
Network Protocol (DNP) 3.0 within P12x MiCOM relays.
P12x uses the Triangle MicroWorks, Inc. DNP 3.0 Slave Source Code Library Version 2.18.
This document, in conjunction with the DNP 3.0 Basic 4 Document Set, and the DNP Subset
Definitions Document, provides complete information on how to communicate with P12x via
the DNP 3.0 protocol.
This implementation of DNP 3.0 is fully compliant with DNP 3.0 Subset Definition Level 2,
contains many Subset Level 3 features, and contains some functionality even beyond
Subset Level 3.
1.2 DNP V3.00 device Profile
The following table provides a “Device Profile Document” in the standard format defined in
the DNP 3.0 Subset Definitions Document. While it is referred to in the DNP 3.0 Subset
Definitions as a “Document,” it is only a component of a total interoperability guide. This
table, in combination with the following should provide a complete
interoperability/configuration guide for P12x:
• the Point List Tables provided in Section 1.4 (beginning on page 8),
DNP V3.00
DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT
(ALSO SEE THE IMPLEMENTATION TABLE IN SECTION 1.3, BEGINNING ON PAGE 6).
Vendor Name: AREVA T&D Antomation & Information
Device Name: SERIAL 20 Platform using the Triangle MicroWorks, Inc. DNP 3.0 Slave
Source Code Library, Version 2.18.
Highest DNP Level Supported: Device Function:
For static (non-change-event) object requests, request qualifier codes 00 and 01 (start-
stop), 07 and 08 (limited quantity), and 17 and 28 (index) are supported in addition to
request qualifier code 06 (no range – or all points).
Static object requests received with qualifiers 00, 01, 06, 07, or 08, will be responded with
qualifiers 00 or 01. Static object requests received with qualifiers 17 or 28 will be
responded with qualifiers 17 or 28.
For change-event object requests, qualifiers 17 or 28 are always responded.
16-bit and 32-bit Analog Change Events with Time may be requested.
The read function code for Object 50 (Time and Date), variation 1, is supported.
Maximum Data Link Frame Size (octets): Maximum Application Fragment Size (octets):
Transmitted: 292 Transmitted: 2048
Received 292 Received: 2048
Maximum Data Link Re-tries: Maximum Application Layer Re-tries:
! None
" Fixed at 2 " None
! Configurable ! Configurable
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
DNP 3.0 Database
Page 4/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
DNP V3.00
DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT
(ALSO SEE THE IMPLEMENTATION TABLE IN SECTION 1.3, BEGINNING ON PAGE 6).
Requires Data Link Layer Confirmation:
" Never
Always
Sometimes
Configurable
Requires Application Layer Confirmation:
Never
Always
" When reporting Event Data
" When sending multi-fragment responses
Sometimes
Configurable
Timeouts while waiting for:
Others:
Binary input change scanning period: 5ms
Analog input change scanning period: 1s
Sends/Executes Control Operations:
DNP V3.00
DEVICE PROFILE DOCUMENT
(ALSO SEE THE IMPLEMENTATION TABLE IN SECTION 1.3, BEGINNING ON PAGE 6).
Default Counter Object/Variation: Counters Roll Over at:
REQUEST RESPONSE
OBJECT
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes Qualifier Function Qualifier
Description (dec)
Number Number Codes (hex) Codes (dec) Codes (hex)
1 0 Binary Input (Variation 0 is used 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)
1 1 Binary Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default – 22 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
see note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
1 2 Binary Input with Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index
2 0 Binary Input Change (Variation 0 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
is used to request default
variation)
2 1(default – Binary Input Change without 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
see note 1 for 07, 08 (limited qty)
Time
P120 - P121)
2 2 Binary Input Change with Time 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
(only P122- (default – 07, 08 (limited qty)
P123) see note 1)
10 0 Binary Output Status (Variation 0 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
is used to request default 07, 08 (limited qty)
variation) 17, 28 (index)
10 2 Binary Output Status 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default – 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
see note 1) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
12 1 Control Relay Output Block 3 (select) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) echo of request
4 (operate) 07, 08 (limited qty)
5 (direct op) 17, 28 (index)
6 (dir. op, noack)
20 0 Binary Counter (Variation 0 is 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all)
used to request default variation) 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited qty)
P123)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 1 32-Bit Binary Counter 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 2 16-Bit Binary Counter 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 5 32-Bit Binary Counter without 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
Flag 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
P123)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
20 6 16-Bit Binary Counter without 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 7 (freeze) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
Flag 8 (freeze noack) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
P123)
9 (freeze clear) 17, 28 (index)
10 (frz. cl. Noack)
21 0 Frozen Counter (Variation 0 is 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all)
used to request default variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
P123)
17, 28 (index)
21 1 32-Bit Frozen Counter 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
DNP 3.0 Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 7/168
REQUEST RESPONSE
OBJECT
(Library will parse) (Library will respond with)
Object Variation Function Codes Qualifier Function Qualifier
Description (dec)
Number Number Codes (hex) Codes (dec) Codes (hex)
21 2 16-Bit Frozen Counter 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
21 9 32-Bit Frozen Counter without 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
Flag 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
P123)
17, 28 (index)
21 10 16-Bit Frozen Counter without 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
Flag 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
P123)
17, 28 (index)
30 0 Analog Input (Variation 0 is used 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all)
to request default variation) 07, 08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)
30 1 32-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(default – 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
see note 1 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
30 2 16-Bit Analog Input 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
30 3 32-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
30 4 16-Bit Analog Input without Flag 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
32 0 Analog Change Event (Variation 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
07, 08 (limited qty)
0 is used to request default
variation)
32 1 32-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
(default – 07, 08 (limited qty)
without Time
see note 1)
32 2 16-Bit Analog Change Event 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
07, 08 (limited qty)
without Time
32 3 32-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
(only P122- 07, 08 (limited qty)
Time
P123)
32 4 16-Bit Analog Change Event with 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all) 129 (response) 17, 28 (index)
(only P122- 07, 08 (limited qty)
Time
P123)
50 0 Time and Date 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) 07, 08 (limited qty) see note 2)
17, 28 (index)
50 1 Time and Date 1 (read) 00, 01 (start-stop) 129 (response) 00, 01 (start-stop)
(only P122- (default – 2 (write) 06 (no range, or all) 17, 28 (index –
P123) see note 1) 07 (limited qty=1) see note 2)
08 (limited qty)
17, 28 (index)
52 2 Time Delay Fine 129 (response) 07 (limited qty)
(qty = 1)
60 0 Class 0, 1, 2, and 3 Data 1 (read) 06 (no range, or all)
1.4.2 Binary Output Status Points and Control Relay Output Blocks
The following table lists both the Binary Output Status Points (Object 10) and the Control
Relay Output Blocks (Object 12). Binary Output Status points are not included in class 0
polls.
1.4.3 Counters
The following table lists both Binary Counters (Object 20) and Frozen Counters (Object 21).
When a freeze function is performed on a Binary Counter point, the frozen value is available
in the corresponding Frozen Counter point.
Binary Counters and Frozen Counters are not included in class 0 polls.
P120 and P121 do not support binary Counters and Frozen Counters.
Binary Counters
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 20
Change Event Object Number: not supported
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read), 7 (freeze), 8 (freeze noack)
9 (freeze and clear), 10 (freeze and clear, noack)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 5 (32-Bit Binary Counter without Flag
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: none-not supported
Frozen Counters
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 21
Change Event Object Number: not supported
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 9 (32-Bit Frozen Binary without Flag)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: none-not supported
P122 P123
Point Point Name/Description Data type
Index Index
0 0 Max RMS current phase A D1
1 1 Max RMS current phase B D1
2 2 Max RMS current phase C D1
3 3 Average RMS current phase A D1
4 4 Average RMS current phase B D1
5 5 Average RMS current phase C D1
6 6 CB operation number D2
7 7 sa2n ia D3
8 8 sa2n ib D3
9 9 sa2n ic D3
10 Total number of autoreclosure cycle D2
11 Number of cycles 1 D2
12 Number of cycles 2 D2
13 Number of cycles 3 D2
14 Number of cycles 4 D2
15 Definitive Tripping number D2
16 Number of closing order D2
10 17 Rolling demand(average) RMS phase A D1
11 18 Rolling demand(average) RMS phase B D1
12 19 Rolling demand(average) RMS phase C D1
13 20 Maximum RMS phase A (after a new initialization) D1
14 21 Maximum RMS phase B (after a new initialization) D1
15 22 Maximum RMS phase C (after a new initialization) D1
Communications P12x/EN CT/F65
DNP 3.0 Database
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 13/168
Analog Inputs
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 30
Change Event Object Number: 32
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Input)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Change Event w/o
Time)
Change Event Scan Rate: The scan rate for analog input change events is fixed at 1s
Scaling Initial
and Units Change Change
P120 P121 P122 P123
Initial (represent Valid Event Event
Point Point Point Point Name/Description
Value ation of Range Dead- Class (1,
Index Index Index Index
32767 – band 2, 3 or
see above) none)
0 0 Active Group 1 32767 1à2 1 1
0 1 1 Magnitude IA 0 40 In 0 to 40 In 0.02 In 3
1 2 2 Magnitude IB 0 40 In 0 to 40 In 0.02 In 3
2 3 3 Magnitude IC 0 40 In 0 to 40 In 0.02 In 3
0 3 4 4 Magnitude IN 0 40 I0n 0 to 40 I0n 0.02 I0n 3
4 5 5 rms IA 0A 327.67A 0 to 3
40000000 2%
A/100
5 6 6 rms IB 0A 327.67A 0 to 3
40000000 2%
A/100
6 7 7 rms IC 0A 327.67A 0 to 3
40000000 2%
A/100
1 7 8 8 rms IN 0A 327.67A 0 to 3
40000000 2%
A/100
9 9 Thermal State 0% 32767% 0 to 65535 10 3
10 10 Frequency 0 327,67 Hz 45Hz to 1Hz 3
65 Hz and
99.99Hz ==
ERROR
11 11 Magnitude I2 0 40 In 0 to 40 In 0.1 In 3
12 12 Magnitude I1 0 40 In 0 to 40 In 0.1 In 3
13 13 Tripping Time 0 327.67s 0 to 10.00s 10 ms 3
14 14 Closing Time 0 327.67s 0 to 10.00s 10 ms 3
15 15 Fault number 0 32767 0 to 65535 1 2
16 16 group 0 32767 1 to 2 each new 2
fault
17 17 phase fault 0 32767 0 to 8 (F1) each new 2
fault
P12x/EN CT/F65 Communications
DNP 3.0 Database
Page 14/168 MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Analog Inputs
Static (Steady-State) Object Number: 30
Change Event Object Number: 32
Request Function Codes supported: 1 (read)
Static Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Input)
Change Event Variation reported when variation 0 requested: 1 (32-Bit Analog Change Event w/o
Time)
Change Event Scan Rate: The scan rate for analog input change events is fixed at 1s
Scaling Initial
and Units Change Change
P120 P121 P122 P123
Initial (represent Valid Event Event
Point Point Point Point Name/Description
Value ation of Range Dead- Class (1,
Index Index Index Index
32767 – band 2, 3 or
see above) none)
18 18 origin fault 0 32767 0 to each new 2
16 (P122) fault
17 (P123)
(F2)
19 19 Fault magnitude 0 40 In 0 to 40 In each new 2
fault
20 20 Fault magnitude IA 0 40 In 0 to 40 In each new 2
fault
21 21 Fault magnitude IB 0 40 In 0 to 40 In each new 2
fault
22 22 Fault magnitude IC 0 40 In 0 to 40 In each new 2
fault
23 23 Fault magnitude IN 0 40 I0n 0 to 40 I0n each new 2
fault
Format:
F1:
0: None, 1: Phase A, 2: Phase B, 3: Phase C, 4: Phase AB, 5: Phase AC, 6: Phase BC, 7:
Phase A B C, 8: Terre
F2:
0: Null, 1: Remote trip, 2: thermal overload, 3: tI>, 4: tI>>, 5: tI>>>, 6: tIN>, 7: tIN>>, 8:
tIN>>>, 9: tI<, 10: broken conductor, 11: taux1, 12: taux2, 13: tIinv>, 14: tIinv>>, 15:taux2,
16: taux3(only p123), 17:breaker failure, 18: SOFT (only P123)..
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Commissioning and
Maintenance Guide
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
CONTENTS
4. SETTING CHECK 10
4.1 Settings 10
4.2 Measurements 10
4.2.1 MiCOM P120 10
4.2.2 MiCOM P121, P122 and P123 10
4.3 Phase overcurrent (I> and I>>) 11
4.3.1 Test wiring diagram 11
4.3.2 MiCOM settings 11
4.4 Final checks 15
P12x/EN CM/F65 Commissioning and Maintenance
5. MAINTENANCE 16
5.1 Equipment failure 16
5.1.1 Minor fault 16
5.1.2 Major fault 16
5.2 Method of repair 17
5.2.1 Replacing the active part 17
5.2.2 Replacing the complete relay 17
5.2.3 Changing the battery (MiCOM P122 & P123 only) 18
5.3 Problem solving 18
5.3.1 Password lost or not accepted 18
5.3.2 Communication 19
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
• Extracting the settings applied to the relay using the appropriate setting software
MiCOM S1 (preferred method)
− Test plugs and wires to carry out injections to the CT's secondary (dimension
according to the currents injected).
2.1.3 Communication
For all commissioning tests, the records can be made by using the RS 485 communication
on the rear connector of the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays or for MiCOM P122
and P123 using the RS232 front port.
According to each RS 485 communication protocol (MODBUS, Courier, IEC 60870-5-103,
DNP3).
2.2 Commissioning test sheets
Commissioning test sheets are available in the APPENDIX 2 of the Technical Guide.
The presentation of the Commissioning test sheets follows the description of the tests of this
chapter.
The contents of these Commissioning test sheets enable you to log :
The name of the relay, station and circuit
The characteristics of the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays
The various settings
The results of the protection and automation checks
The result of the test records after commissioning.
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
P1 S1
P2 S2
Other ends
of electrical cables
P0041ENa
Busbar 1 Busbar 2
Circuit Breaker 1 Electrical line Circuit Breaker 2
P121
with CT core
Earthing 1 Earthing 2
P0042ENa
_
P1 S1 + mA
+
_
P2 S2
P0043ENa
OP. PARAMETERS/Inputs
Input MiCOM P12x models
Status cell value
Opto input 1
P120,P121, P122, P123 00001
22-24 Terminals
Opto input 2
P120,P121, P122, P123 00010
26-28 Terminals
Opto input 3
P122, P123 00100
17-19 Terminals
Opto input 4
P123 01000
21-23 Terminals
Opto input 5
P123 10000
25-27 Terminals
OP. PARAMETERS/Relay
OUTPUT MiCOM P12x models
Status cell value
RL 1 P120,P121, P122, P123 00000001
RL 2 P120,P121, P122, P123 00000010
RL 3 P120,P121, P122, P123 00000100
RL 4 P120,P121, P122, P123 00001000
RL 5 P122, P123 00010000
RL 6 P122, P123 00100000
RL 7 P123 01000000
RL 8 P123 10000000
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
4. SETTING CHECK
The setting checks ensure that all of the application-specific relay setting for the particular
installation have been correctly applied to the relay.
Transfer the setting file to the relay using a laptop PC running the appropriate software via
the RS232 front port (MiCOM P122 and P123) or the RS485 rear port (all MiCOM models).
This method is preferred transfer function settings because it is much faster and there is less
margin for error.
If the setting software is not used then enter manually via the relay front panel interface.
The commissioning is following the points below:
− Apply current to input terminals 55-56 or 47-48 and verify the value on the LCD
display.
− Carry forward the results to the Commissioning test sheets (Applied value and relay
value displayed)
4.2.2 MiCOM P121, P122 and P123
− Apply current to input (as per wiring diagram) and verify the values on the LCD
display.
− Carry forward the results to the Commissioning test sheets (Applied values and relay
values displayed).
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
INJECTION
TEST SET
AUXILIARY +Uaux 33
-Uaux
SUPPLY 34
A 49
1A
50
51
1A
CURRENT
MiCOM
52
53
1A 1A
N
P121
54
41
A 5A
42
43
CURRENT 5A
5A 44
45
5A
N 46
35 Case earth
36 WD Watchdog
29
6 -
TIMER Stop 4
2 RL1 Trip output * 30
12 31
+ RS 485 communication port
10
RL2 Programmable output 32
8 -
P0044ENa
Ie> YES
Ie> 1 In
tIe> DMT or IDMT or RI
tIe> (if DMT) 20 s
Type of curve (if IDMT) IEC VI or IEEE VI
TMS value (if IDMT) 1
K value (if RI) 1
Ie>> YES
Ie>> 12 In
tIe>> 10 s
P12x/EN CM/F65 Commissioning and Maintenance
I> YES
I> 1 In
tI> DMT or IDMT or RI
tI> (if DMT) 20 s
Type of curve (if IDMT) IEC VI or IEEE VI
TMS value (if IDMT) 1
K value (if RI) 1
I>> YES
I>> 12 In
IEEE/ANSI curves
RI electromechanical curve
Rectifier curve
Laborelec curve
For other injected current values, compare the values found with the theoretical values
calculated according to the formulae of the curves.
NOTE : Equations of IEC, IEEE/ANSI, RI, RC and Laborelec curves are given
in Chapter "Application Guide" of the present Technical Guide.
Checks :
Display of an alarm message on the front panel LCD.
Alarm LED flashes.
Trip LED on
I> threshold LED on (if programmed).
Trip output closes.
I> threshold output closes (if programmed).
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
5. MAINTENANCE
5.1 Equipment failure
MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays are full digital and self-diagnosing. As soon as
an internal fault is detected, depending on its type (minor or major), an alarm message is
displayed as a priority on the front panel LCD before the fault LED is illuminated (fixed or
flashing) and the watchdog relay is closed (if the fault is a major one).
An equipment failure (major or minor) cannot be acknowledged on the front panel (using the
dedicated tactile button keypad). Only the disappearance of the cause will acknowledge the
fault and hence reset the fault LED.
All tests are performed during relay boot and permanently in the background software task
excepted EEPROM tests performed only when relay boots and on any setting change.
All tests are performed during relay boot and permanently in the background software task
excepted EEPROM tests performed only when relay boots and on any setting change.
5.1.1 Minor fault
Regarded by the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays as a minor fault is a
communication failure. If the communication is in fault, MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123
protection and automation modules are not affected. The MiCOM relay is fully operational.
The watchdog relay is energised (35-36 contact open and 36-37 contact closed).
Message :
"COMM.ERROR" : Communication fault
Cause :
Hardware or software failure of the communication module
Action :
Withdraw the active part and return it to the factory for repair.
Alternative : If communication is not used, disable communication in the COMMUNICATION
menu (Communication ? = No).
Message :
"RAM ERROR" : Ram supplied by battery in fault.
"Battery Fail" : Battery in fault.
Cause :
See Section 5.2.3 of this Commissioning and Maintenance Guide.
If the message still remain after restart, return the module to the factory for repair.
5.1.2 Major fault
Major fault for MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays are all software and hardware
failures except the communication faults. As soon as this type of failure is detected, the
watchdog (WD) is de-energised (35-36 contact closed and 36-37 contact open) and all
operations are stopped (protection, automation, communication).
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
• Gently extract the battery from its socket. If necessary, use a small screwdriver.
• Ensure that metal terminals in the battery socket are free from corrosion, grease and
dust.
• The replacement battery should be removed from its packaging and placed into the
battery holder, ensure that the polarity markings on the battery agree with those
adjacent to the socket.
NOTE :
ONLY USE A TYPE 1/2AA LITHIUM BATTERY WITH A NOMINAL VOLTAGE OF 3.6 V.
• Ensure that the battery is securely held in its socket and that the battery terminals are
making good contact with the metal terminals of the socket.
• The battery that has been removed should be disposed of in accordance with the
disposal procedure for Lithium batteries in the country in which the relay is installed.
5.3 Problem solving
5.3.1 Password lost or not accepted
Problem :
Password lost or not accepted
Cause :
MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays are supplied with the password set to AAAA.
This password can be changed by the user ( refer OP PARAMETERS menu).
Action :
There is an additional unique recovery password associated to the relay which can be
supplied by the factory or service agent, if given details of its serial number (under the upper
flap of the front panel). With this serial number, contact your AREVA T&D'S Automation &
Information Systems Business local dealer or AREVA T&D'S Automation & Information
Systems Business After Sales Dept.
Commissioning and Maintenance P12x/EN CM/F65
5.3.2 Communication
5.3.2.1 Values measured locally and remotely
Problem :
The measurements noted remotely and locally (via RS485 communication) differ.
Cause :
The values accessible on the front face via the Measurement menu are refreshed every
second. Those fed back via the communication and accessible by the AREVA T&D'S
Automation & Information Systems Business Setting software generally have skeletal
refreshing frequencies. If the refreshing frequency of the supervision software differs from
that of MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays (1s), there may be a difference between
indicated values.
Action:
Adjust the frequency for refreshing the measurements of the supervision software or of the
setting software to 1 second.
5.3.2.2 MiCOM relay no longer responds
Problem :
No response from MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 relays when asked by the
supervision software without any communication fault message.
Cause :
Mainly, this type of problem is linked to an error in the MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123
communication parameters.
Action :
Check MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 communication parameters (data rate, parity,
etc.) are in accordance with the supervision settings.
Check MiCOM P120, P121, P122 and P123 network address.
Check that this address is not used by another device connected on the same LAN.
Check that the other devices on the same LAN answer to supervision requests.
5.3.2.3 A remote command is not taken in account
Problem :
The communication between the relay and the PC is correct, but the relay does not accept
any remote command or file downloading.
Cause :
Generally this is due to the fact that the relay is in programming situation. This means that
the password is active.
Action :
Check that the password is not active in the relay since the last 5 minutes.
P12x/EN CM/F65 Commissioning and Maintenance
BLANK PAGE
Connection Diagrams P12x/EN CO/F65
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Connection Diagrams
Alternative : The earth current input is connected to the sommation of the three phase CTs. The current inputs are connected to 3 phase CTs + a core balanced CT.
P2 P1 P2 P1 P2 P1 37
A A 33 35
S2 S1 S2 S1 Auxiliary + WD Watch dog (4)
B B 36
voltage
}
C C _ 6
S2 S1 34
49 49 4
Programmable tripping
P121 RL1
2
} output
1A 1A
50 50 12
51 51 10
RL2 Programmable output
1A 1A P121 8
}
A only
52 52 16
53 53 RL3 Programmable output
14 }
1A 1A 20
54 54 RL4 18 Programmable output
55 55 }
Connection Diagrams
C B
1A 1A
Phase rotation
56 56
41 P121 41
5A 5A
42 42
43 43
5A 5A P121
only
44 44
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
45 45
5A 5A
46 46
47 47
5A 5A MiCOM
48 48
+ P120/121
Programmable 22
input L1 Case earth connection
24
-
Alternative (P121 only): Connection to 2 phases CTs + a core balanced CT.
{ +
Programmable 26
input L2
P2 P1 P2 P1 28
A -
{
S2 S1 Case earth
B 29
Communication
C 30 cable shield
S2 S1 1 2 29 30 *
49
3 4 31 32
1A 31 _ RS 485
5 6 33 34
50 Port communication
7 8 35 36
51
9 10 37 38 32
1A +
11 12 39 40
}
( : terminating resistor for the
52 13 14 41 42 *
53 last relay to be connected
15 16 43 44 between 30-32)
1A
17 18 45 46
54
42
43 (b) Short terminals break before (c)
Module terminal blocks
5A (c) Long terminals
viewed from rear
44 (d)
45 (with integral case earth link) Pins terminals (pcb type)
48
P0045ENb
Page 1/4
P12x/EN CO/F65
Alternative : The earth current input is connected to the sommation of the three phase CTs. The current inputs are connected to 3 phase CTs + a core balanced CT.
P2 P1 P2 P1 P2 P1 37
A A 33 35
S2 S1 S2 S1 Auxiliary + Watch dog (4)
B B WD 36
}
voltage{ _ 6
Page 2/4
C C 34
S2 S1 Programmable tripping
49 49 4
RL1 output
2 }
1A 1A
50 50 12
51 51 10
RL2 Programmable output
8
1A
A
1A
}
52 52 16
53 53
P12x/EN CO/F65
+ P122/123
Programmable 22
input L1
{ 24 Case earth connection
-
Alternative : Connection to 2 phases CTs + a core balanced CT. +
Programmable 26
input L2
P2 P1 P2 P1 { 28
A -
+
S2 S1 Case earth Programmable 17
B L3 29
input { 19 Communication
C - cable shield
S2 S1 1 2 29 30 + 30
49 Programmable 21 *
3 4 31 32 input L4
1A
{ 23 31 _
5 6 33 34 - RS 485
+
50 Programmable 25 Port communication
7 8 35 36
51 input L5
9 10 37 38 { 27 32 }
1A - +
11 12 39 40 ( : terminating resistor for the
52 13 14 41 42 *
53 P123 only last relay to be connected
15 16 43 44 between 30-32)
1A
17 18 45 46
54
19 20 47 48
42
43 (b) Short terminals break before (c)
Module terminal blocks
5A (c) Long terminals
viewed from rear
44 (d)
45 (with integral case earth link) Pins terminals (pcb type)
48
P0046ENb
Connection Diagrams
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Connection Diagrams P12x/EN CO/F65
29
30
32 31
shield
RS485 cable
P0253ENa
P12x/EN CO/F65 Connection Diagrams
EARTH
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
CONTENTS
BLANK PAGE
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Commissioning date :
Engineer :
Substation :
Circuit :
Network nominal frequency:
Serial number :
Rated current In :
Auxiliary voltage Uaux :
Communication protocol :
Language :
Insulation tested ?
Watchdog contacts
With auxiliary supply off Terminals 35 and 36
Measurements
Applied value Relay value
PHASE CT INPUT
Phase A current _______________ A A
Phase B current _______________ A A
Phase C current _______________ A A
EARTH CT INPUT
Earth current _______________ A A
Phase protection test
Theoretical value Relay value
I> threshold _______________ A
I> threshold A
I> drop threshold A
Time delay
Time delay at 2 x I> ______________ ms A
Time delay at 10 x I> ______________ ms A
I>> threshold _______________ A
I>> threshold _______________A
I>> drop threshold _______________A
Time delay
Time delay at 2 x I>> _______________ A A
Time delay at 10 x I>> _______________ A A
Earth protection test
Theoretical value Relay value
Ie> threshold _______________ A
Ie> threshold _______________A
Ie> drop threshold _______________A
Time delay
Time delay at 2 x Ie> ______________ ms ms
Time delay at 10 x Ie> ______________ ms ms
Ie>> threshold _______________ A
Ie>> threshold _______________A
Ie>> drop threshold _______________A
Time delay
Time delay at 2 x Ie>> ______________ ms ms
Time delay at 10 x Ie>> ______________ ms ms
Commissioning Engineer Date
_________________________ ______________
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Password :
Reference :
Frequency :
! 50 Hz ! 60 Hz
E/Gnd text ! N ! E ! G
2.1.2.2 CT Ratio
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Relay Address
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Ie> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.1.4.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Ie>>
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
tIe>> ms
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
Trip tIe>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
2.1.5.2 Latch Function allocation
Latch tIe>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
2.1.5.3 Blocking logic allocation
Block tIe> =
! YES ! NO
Block tIe>> =
! YES ! NO
Block tIe>>> =
! YES ! NO
2.1.5.4 Output Relays allocation (RL2 to RL4)
Functions RL 2 RL 3 RL 4
Input 1
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
Password :
Reference :
Software version :
Frequency :
! 50 Hz ! 60 Hz
Phase A Text ! A ! L1 ! R
Phase B Text ! B ! L2 ! S
Phase C Text ! C ! L3 ! T
E/Gnd Text ! N ! E ! G
2.2.2.2 CT Ratio
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Relay Address
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
I>?
! YES ! NO
I> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.2.4.1.1.1 [51] I> DMT
tI> ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
I>>?
! YES ! NO
I>> In
tI>> ms
I>>>?
! YES ! NO
I>>> In
tI>>> ms
Ie>?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.2.4.2.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
Ie>>?
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
tIe>> ms
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
Trip tI>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
2.2.5.2 Latch function allocation
Latch tI>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Block tI>
! YES ! NO
Block tI>>
! YES ! NO
Block tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Block tIe>
! YES ! NO
Block tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Block tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
2.2.5.4 OUTPUT RELAYS allocation (RL2 to RL4)
Functions RL 2 RL 3 RL 4
Input 1
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
Password :
Reference :
Software version :
Frequency :
! 50 Hz ! 60 Hz
Phase A Text ! A ! L1 ! R
Phase B Text ! B ! L2 ! S
Phase C Text ! C ! L3 ! T
E/Gnd Text ! N ! E ! G
2.3.2.2 CT Ratio
Inputs 3 2 1
! ! !
Voltage input DC ! DC ! AC
Relays 6 5 W 4 3 2 1
CMD
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Relay Address
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
I> ?
! YES ! NO
I> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.4.1.1.1 [51] I> DMT
tI> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
I>> ?
! YES ! NO
I>> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.4.1.2.1 [51] I>> DMT
tI>> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>>>?
! YES ! NO
I>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
I>>> In
tI>>> ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Ie>?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.3.4.2.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.3.4.2.2 [51N] Ie>>
Ie>>?
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.3.4.2.2.1 [51N] Ie >> DMT
tIe>> ms
t Reset ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.3.4.2.3 [51N] Ie>>>
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
Therm OL ?
! YES ! NO
Iθ> In
Te mn
k
θ Trip %
θ Alarm ? ! YES ! NO
θ Alarm %
I< ?
! YES ! NO
I< %
tI< ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
I2> ?
! YES ! NO
I2> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.4.5.1 [46] I2> DMT
tI> ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I2>> ?
! YES ! NO
I2>> In
tI2>> ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
I> ?
! YES ! NO
I> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.5.1.1.1 [51] I> DMT
tI> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>> ?
! YES ! NO
I>> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.5.1.2.1 [51] I>> DMT
tI>> ms
t Reset ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>>>?
! YES ! NO
I>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
I>>> In
tI>>> ms
Ie>?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.3.5.2.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
t Reset ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.3.5.2.2 [51N] Ie>>
Ie>>?
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.3.5.2.2.1 [51N] Ie >> DMT
tIe>> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.3.5.2.3 [51N] Ie>>>
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
Therm OL ?
! YES ! NO
Iθ> In
Te mn
k
θ Trip %
θ Alarm ? ! YES ! NO
θ Alarm %
I< ?
! YES ! NO
I< %
tI< ms
I2> ?
! YES ! NO
I2> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.3.5.5.1 [46] I2> DMT
tI> ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I2>> ?
! YES ! NO
I2>> In
tI2>> ms
Trip tI>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI<
! YES ! NO
Trip tI2>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Trip Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Trip Brkn. Cond
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux1
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux2
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux3
! YES ! NO
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Latch tI>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI<
! YES ! NO
Latch tI2>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Latch Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Latch Brkn .Cond
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux1
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux2
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux3
! YES ! NO
2.3.6.3 Blocking Logic 1 function allocation
Block 1 tI>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI<
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI2>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Block 1 Brkn .Cond
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux1
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux2
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux3
! YES ! NO
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Block 2 tI>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI<
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI2>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Block 2 Brkn .Cond
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux1
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux2
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux3
! YES ! NO
2.3.6.5 SELECTIVE SCHEME LOGIC1 function allocation
Logic Select 1
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
t SeL1 ms
Logic Select 2
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
t Sel2 ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Functions RL 2 RL 3 RL 4
Trip ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI< ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI2> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI2>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Therm Alarm ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Therm Trip ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Alarm ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
52 Fail ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Brkn cond ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Fail ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Close ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux1 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux2 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux3 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 1 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 2 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 3 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 4 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Active Group ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Functions RL 5 RL 6
Trip ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
I>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Ie>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tIe>>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI< ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI2> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tI2>> ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Therm Alarm ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Therm Trip ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Alarm ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
52 Fail ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Brkn cond ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Fail ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
CB Close ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux1 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux2 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
tAux3 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 1 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 2 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 3 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Order COM 4 ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Active Group ! YES ! NO ! YES ! NO
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
2.3.6.8.1 Inputs
tCL ms
CB Fail ?
! YES ! NO
I< In
tBF ms
Block I> ?
! YES ! NO
Block Ie> ?
! YES ! NO
2.3.6.12 CIRCUIT BREAKER SUPERVISION
TC Supervision ?
! YES ! NO
t SUP s
CB Open S'vision
! YES ! NO
CB Open Time ms
CB Close S'vision
! YES ! NO
CB Close Time ms
CB Open Alarm ?
! YES ! NO
CB Open NB
Σ Amps (n) ? ! YES ! NO
Σ Amps (n)
n
t Open Pulse ms
t Close Pulse ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Pre-Time ms
Post-Time ms
Disturb Rec Trig
! ON INST. ! ON TRIP
2.3.7.2 TIME PEAK VALUE
Time Window mn
Sub Period mn
Num of Sub Per.
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Password :
Reference :
Software version :
Frequency :
! 50 Hz ! 60 Hz
2.4.2 CONFIGURATION Menu
2.4.2.1 Display
Phase A Text ! A ! L1 ! R
Phase B Text ! B ! L2 ! S
Phase C Text ! C ! L3 ! T
E/Gnd Text ! N ! E ! G
2.4.2.2 CT Ratio
Setting group ! 1 ! 2
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Inputs 3 2 1
! ! !
Voltage input DC ! DC ! AC
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Relay Address
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
Communication ?
! YES ! NO
Baud Rate
! 300 bds ! 600 bds
I> ?
! YES ! NO
I> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.4.1.1.1 [51] I> DMT
tI> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>> ?
! YES ! NO
I>> In
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.4.1.2.1 [51] I>> DMT
tI>> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>>>?
! YES ! NO
I>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
I>>> In
tI>>> ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Ie> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.4.4.2.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.4.4.2.2 [51N] Ie>>
Ie>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.4.4.2.2.1 [51N] Ie >> DMT
tIe>> ms
t Reset ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.4.4.2.3 [51N] Ie >>>
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
[49] Therm OL ?
! YES ! NO
Iθ> In
Te mn
k
θ Trip %
[49] θ Alarm ? ! YES ! NO
θ Alarm %
I< ?
! YES ! NO
I< %
tI< ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
I2>?
! YES ! NO
I2> In
Delay Trip
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.4.5.1 [46] I2> DMT
tI2> ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I2>>?
! YES ! NO
I2>> In
tI2>> ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
I> ? ! YES ! NO
I> In
Delay Type ! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.5.1.1.1 [51] I> DMT
tI> ms
t Reset ms
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>> ? ! YES ! NO
I>> In
Delay Type ! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.5.1.2.1 [51] I>> DMT
tI>> ms
t Reset ms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I>>>?
! YES ! NO
I>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
I>>> In
tI>>> ms
Ie> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.4.5.2.1.1 [51N] Ie > DMT
tIe> ms
t Reset ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
!1 !2 !3
2.4.5.2.2 [51N] Ie>>
Ie>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>> Ien
Delay Type
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI ! LABOR.
2.4.5.2.2.1 [51N] Ie >> DMT
tIe>> ms
t Reset ms
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
! IEEE RC
Tms
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
Idmt
! 1 ! 2 ! 3
2.4.5.2.3 [51N] Ie >>>
Ie>>> ?
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Sample
! YES ! NO
Ie>>> Ien
tIe>>> ms
[49] Therm OL ?
! YES ! NO
Iθ> In
Te mn
k
θ Trip %
[49] θ Alarm ? ! YES ! NO
θ Alarm %
I< ?
! YES ! NO
I< %
tI< ms
I2>?
! YES ! NO
I2> In
Delay Trip
! IDMT ! DMT ! RI
2.4.5.5.1 [46] I2> DMT
tI2> ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Idmt
! IEC SI ! IEC STI
! IEC VI ! IEC EI
! IEEE MI ! CO8
! IEEE VI ! IEEE EI
Tms
t Reset ms
Rtms
K
t Reset ms
I2>>?
! YES ! NO
I2>> In
tI2>> ms
[79] Autoreclose ?
! YES ! NO
Ext CB Fail ?
! YES ! NO
Ext CB Fail Time ms
Ext Block ?
! YES ! NO
Aux 1 (I>)
! YES ! NO
Aux 2 (Ie>)
! YES ! NO
Dead Time tD1 ms
Dead Time tD2 ms
Dead Time tD3 ms
Dead Time tD4 ms
Reclaim Time tR ms
Inhib Time tI ms
Phase Cycles
E/Gnd Cycles
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tI>
! ! ! !
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tI>>
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tI>>>
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tIe>
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tIe>>
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tIe>>>
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tAux 1
! ! ! !
4 3 2 1
CYCLES tAux 2
! ! ! !
2.4.6 AUTOMAT.CTRL Menu
2.4.6.1 TRIP Command allocation
Trip tI>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI<
! YES ! NO
Trip tI2>
! YES ! NO
Trip tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Trip Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Trip Brkn Cond
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux1
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux2
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux3
! YES ! NO
Trip tAux4
! YES ! NO
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Latch tI>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI<
! YES ! NO
Latch tI2>
! YES ! NO
Latch tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Latch Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Latch Brkn . Cond
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux1
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux2
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux3
! YES ! NO
Latch tAux4
! YES ! NO
2.4.6.3 Blocking Logic 1 function allocation
Block 1 tI>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI<
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI2>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Block 1 Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Block 1 Brkn. Cond
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux1
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux2
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux3
! YES ! NO
Block 1 tAux4
! YES ! NO
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Block 2 tI>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI<
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI2>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tI2>>
! YES ! NO
Block 2 Thermal θ ! YES ! NO
Block 2 Brkn. Cond
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux1
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux2
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux3
! YES ! NO
Block 2 tAux4
! YES ! NO
2.4.6.5 Selective Scheme Logic1 function allocation
Logic Select 1
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Sel1 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
t Sel1 ms
Logic Select 2
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tI>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tI>>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tIe>>
! YES ! NO
Sel2 tIe>>>
! YES ! NO
tSel2 = ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
Functions RL 2 RL 3 RL 4
Functions RL 2 RL 3 RL 4
Functions RL 5 RL 6 RL 7 RL8
Functions RL 5 RL 6 RL 7 RL8
2.4.6.8.1 Inputs
Input 1
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
! Strt tBF
Input 2
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
! Strt tBF
Input 3
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
! Strt tBF
Input 4
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
! Strt tBF
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
Input 5
! None ! Unlatch ! 52a
Ratio I2/I1 %
tCL ms
Commissioning Test & Record Sheets P12x/EN RS/F65
CB Fail ? ! YES ! NO
tBF ms
I< In
Block I> ? ! YES ! NO
Block Ie> ? ! YES ! NO
2.4.6.12 CIRCUIT BREAKER SUPERVISION
TC Supervision? ! YES ! NO
t SUP s
Σ Amps(n)? ! YES ! NO
Σ Amps(n)
t Open Pulse ms
t Close Pulse ms
Pre-time ms
Post-time ms
Disturb Rec Trig
! ON INST. ! ON TRIP
2.4.7.2 TIME PEAK VALUE
Time Window mn
Sub Period mn
Num of Sub Per.
P12x/EN RS/F65 Commissioning Test & Record Sheets
BLANK PAGE
Hardware/Software Version P12x/EN VC/F65
History and Compatibility
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123
Hardware/Software Version
P120 P121 P122 P123
History and Compatibility
Hardware/Software Version P12x/EN VC/F65
History and Compatibility
MiCOM P120/P121/P122/P123 Page 1/10
BLANK PAGE
Publication: P12x/EN T/F65